1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2    Copyright (C) 1994-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3    Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4 
5    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6 
7    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10    (at your option) any later version.
11 
12    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
15    GNU General Public License for more details.
16 
17    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18    along with this program; if not, write to the
19    Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20    Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
21 
22 
23 /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI.  The
24    information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI.  It includes
25    suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26    information may also not match.  */
27 
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 #include "dwarf2.h"
38 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39 
40 /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1.  */
41 #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
42 
43 typedef enum split16_format_type
44 {
45   split16a_type = 0,
46   split16d_type
47 }
48 split16_format_type;
49 
50 /* RELA relocations are used here.  */
51 
52 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
53   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
54 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
55   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
56 
57 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs.  */
58 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
59 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions.  */
60 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
61 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA.  */
62 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
63 
64 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter.  This is put in the .interp
65    section.  */
66 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
67 
68 /* For old-style PLT.  */
69 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots).  */
70 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
71 
72 /* For new-style .glink and .plt.  */
73 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
74 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h)					\
75   ((4*4									\
76     + (h != NULL							\
77        && h == htab->tls_get_addr					\
78        && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0)			\
79     + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1)				\
80    & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
81 
82 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker.  */
83 
84 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry.  */
85 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
86 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
87     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
88   {
89     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0		 */
90     0x818c0000, /* lwz	   r12,0(r12)		 */
91     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr   r12			 */
92     0x4e800420, /* bctr				 */
93     0x39600000, /* li	   r11,0		 */
94     0x48000000, /* b	   14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
95     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
96     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
97   };
98 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
99     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
100   {
101     0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
102     0x818c0000, /* lwz	 r12,0(r12) */
103     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
104     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
105     0x39600000, /* li	 r11,0 */
106     0x48000000, /* b	 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
107     0x60000000, /* nop */
108     0x60000000, /* nop */
109   };
110 
111 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry.  */
112 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
113 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
114     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
115   {
116     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0	*/
117     0x398c0000, /* addi	   r12,r12,0	*/
118     0x800c0008, /* lwz	   r0,8(r12)	*/
119     0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr   r0		*/
120     0x818c0004, /* lwz	   r12,4(r12)	*/
121     0x4e800420, /* bctr			*/
122     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
123     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
124   };
125 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
126     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
127   {
128     0x819e0008, /* lwz	 r12,8(r30) */
129     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12	    */
130     0x819e0004, /* lwz	 r12,4(r30) */
131     0x4e800420, /* bctr		    */
132     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
133     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
134     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
135     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
136   };
137 
138 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
139    .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader.  */
140 
141 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
142 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
143 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
144 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
145 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
146    a shared library. */
147 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
148 
149 /* Some instructions.  */
150 #define ADDIS_11_11	0x3d6b0000
151 #define ADDIS_11_30	0x3d7e0000
152 #define ADDIS_12_12	0x3d8c0000
153 #define ADDI_11_11	0x396b0000
154 #define ADD_0_11_11	0x7c0b5a14
155 #define ADD_3_12_2	0x7c6c1214
156 #define ADD_11_0_11	0x7d605a14
157 #define B		0x48000000
158 #define BA		0x48000002
159 #define BCL_20_31	0x429f0005
160 #define BCTR		0x4e800420
161 #define BEQLR		0x4d820020
162 #define CMPWI_11_0	0x2c0b0000
163 #define LIS_11		0x3d600000
164 #define LIS_12		0x3d800000
165 #define LWZU_0_12	0x840c0000
166 #define LWZ_0_12	0x800c0000
167 #define LWZ_11_3	0x81630000
168 #define LWZ_11_11	0x816b0000
169 #define LWZ_11_30	0x817e0000
170 #define LWZ_12_3	0x81830000
171 #define LWZ_12_12	0x818c0000
172 #define MR_0_3		0x7c601b78
173 #define MR_3_0		0x7c030378
174 #define MFLR_0		0x7c0802a6
175 #define MFLR_12		0x7d8802a6
176 #define MTCTR_0		0x7c0903a6
177 #define MTCTR_11	0x7d6903a6
178 #define MTLR_0		0x7c0803a6
179 #define NOP		0x60000000
180 #define SUB_11_11_12	0x7d6c5850
181 
182 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block.  */
183 #define TP_OFFSET	0x7000
184 #define DTP_OFFSET	0x8000
185 
186 /* The value of a defined global symbol.  */
187 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
188   ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma	\
189    + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset		\
190    + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
191 
192 /* Relocation HOWTO's.  */
193 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
194    field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
195    always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
196    PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
197    the LSB.  For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
198    and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
199    rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0.  */
200 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
201 	    complain, special_func)				\
202   HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0,	\
203 	 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func,		\
204 	 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
205 
206 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
207 
208 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
209   /* This reloc does nothing.  */
210   HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
211        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
212 
213   /* A standard 32 bit relocation.  */
214   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
215        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
216 
217   /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
218      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
219   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
220        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
221 
222   /* A standard 16 bit relocation.  */
223   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
224        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
225 
226   /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow.  */
227   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
228        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
229 
230   /* The high order 16 bits of an address.  */
231   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
232        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
233 
234   /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
235      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
236   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
237        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
238 
239   /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
240      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
241   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
242        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
243 
244   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
245      indicate that the branch is expected to be taken.	The lower two
246      bits must be zero.  */
247   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
248        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
249 
250   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
251      indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower
252      two bits must be zero.  */
253   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
254        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
255 
256   /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
257   HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
258        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
259 
260   /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
261   HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
262        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
263 
264   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
265      the branch is expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must be
266      zero.  */
267   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
268        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
269 
270   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
271      the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must
272      be zero.  */
273   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
274        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
275 
276   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
277      symbol.  */
278   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
279        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
280 
281   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
282      the symbol.  */
283   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
284        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
285 
286   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
287      the symbol.  */
288   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
289        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
290 
291   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
292      the symbol.  */
293   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
294        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
295 
296   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
297      entry for the symbol.  */
298   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
299        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
300 
301   /* This is used only by the dynamic linker.  The symbol should exist
302      both in the object being run and in some shared library.  The
303      dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
304      shared library into the object, because the object being
305      run has to have the data at some particular address.  */
306   HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
307        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
308 
309   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
310      entries.  */
311   HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
312        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
313 
314   /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol.  */
315   HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
316        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
317 
318   /* Used only by the dynamic linker.  When the object is run, this
319      longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
320      addend.  */
321   HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
322        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
323 
324   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
325      object rather than the final value.  Normally used for
326      _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
327   HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
328        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
329 
330   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned.  */
331   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
332        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
333 
334   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned.  */
335   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
336        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
337 
338   /* 32-bit PC relative */
339   HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
340        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
341 
342   /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
343      FIXME: not supported.  */
344   HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
345        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
346 
347   /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
348      FIXME: not supported.  */
349   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
350        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
351 
352   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
353      the symbol.  */
354   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
355        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
356 
357   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
358      the symbol.  */
359   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
360        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
361 
362   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
363      the symbol.  */
364   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
365        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
366 
367   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
368      small data items.  */
369   HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
370        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
371 
372   /* 16-bit section relative relocation.  */
373   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
374        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
375 
376   /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation.  */
377   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
378        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
379 
380   /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation.  */
381   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
382        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
383 
384   /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation.  */
385   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
386        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
387 
388   /* Marker relocs for TLS.  */
389   HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
390        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391 
392   HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
393        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394 
395   HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
396        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
397 
398   /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions.  */
399   HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
400        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401 
402   HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
403        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
404 
405   /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
406      definition of its TLS sym.  */
407   HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
408        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
409 
410   /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
411      of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
412      contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000.  */
413   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
414        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
415 
416   /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc.  */
417   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
418        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
419 
420   /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
421   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
422        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
423 
424   /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
425   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
426        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
427 
428   /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
429   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
430        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
431 
432   /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
433      sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13).  */
434   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
435        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
436 
437   /* A 16 bit tprel reloc.  */
438   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
439        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
440 
441   /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
442   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
443        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
444 
445   /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
446   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
447        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
448 
449   /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
450   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
451        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
452 
453   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
454      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
455      to the first entry.  */
456   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
457        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
458 
459   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow.  */
460   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
461        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
462 
463   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
464   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
465        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
466 
467   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
468   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
469        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
470 
471   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
472      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
473      first entry.  */
474   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
475        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
476 
477   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow.  */
478   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
479        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
480 
481   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
482   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
483        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
484 
485   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
486   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
487        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
488 
489   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
490      the offset to the entry.  */
491   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
492        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
493 
494   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
495   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
496        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
497 
498   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
499   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
500        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
501 
502   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
503   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
504        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
505 
506   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
507      offset to the entry.  */
508   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
509        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
510 
511   /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
512   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
513        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
514 
515   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
516   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
517        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
518 
519   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
520   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
521        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
522 
523   /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
524      in the SVR4 ELF ABI.  */
525 
526   /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
527   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
528        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
529 
530   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
531   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
532        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
533 
534   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
535   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
536        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
537 
538   /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol.  */
539   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
540        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
541 
542   /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
543      plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
544      is negative.  */
545   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
546        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
547 
548   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
549      address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
550      _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
551   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
552        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
553 
554   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
555      address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
556      _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
557   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
558        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
559 
560   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
561      small data items.	 */
562   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
563        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
564 
565   /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
566      signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
567      field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
568   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
569        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
570 
571   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
572   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
573   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
574   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
575   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
576   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
577 
578   /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
579      in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
580      register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
581   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
582        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
583 
584   /* A relative 8 bit branch.  */
585   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
586        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
587 
588   /* A relative 15 bit branch.  */
589   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
590        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
591 
592   /* A relative 24 bit branch.  */
593   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
594        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
595 
596   /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format.  */
597   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
598        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
599 
600   /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format.  */
601   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
602        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
603 
604   /* Bits 16-31 split16a format.  */
605   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
606        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
607 
608   /* Bits 16-31 split16d format.  */
609   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
610        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
611 
612   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format.  */
613   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
614        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
615 
616   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format.  */
617   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
618        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
619 
620   /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
621      instructions.  If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
622      the e_add16i to an e_li instruction.  */
623   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
624        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
625 
626   /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow.  */
627   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
628        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
629 
630   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
631   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
632        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
633 
634   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
635   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
636        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
637 
638   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
639   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
640        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
641 
642   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
643   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
644        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
645 
646   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format.  */
647   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
648        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
649 
650   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format.  */
651   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
652        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
653 
654   /* e_li split20 format.  */
655   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
656        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657 
658   HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
659        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
660 
661   /* A 16 bit relative relocation.  */
662   HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
663        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
664 
665   /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow.  */
666   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
667        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
668 
669   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address.  */
670   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
671        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
672 
673   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
674      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
675   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
676        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
677 
678   /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis.  */
679   HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
680        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
681 
682   /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only).  */
683   HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
684        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
685 
686   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy.  */
687   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
688        NULL),
689 
690   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage.  */
691   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
692        NULL),
693 
694   /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries.  */
695   HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
696        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
697 };
698 
699 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done.  */
700 
701 static void
ppc_elf_howto_init(void)702 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
703 {
704   unsigned int i, type;
705 
706   for (i = 0;
707        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
708        i++)
709     {
710       type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
711       if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
712 		   / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
713 	abort ();
714       ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
715     }
716 }
717 
718 static reloc_howto_type *
ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)719 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
720 			   bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
721 {
722   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
723 
724   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
725   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
726     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
727 
728   switch (code)
729     {
730     default:
731       return NULL;
732 
733     case BFD_RELOC_NONE:		r = R_PPC_NONE;			break;
734     case BFD_RELOC_32:			r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
735     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26:		r = R_PPC_ADDR24;		break;
736     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
737     case BFD_RELOC_16:			r = R_PPC_ADDR16;		break;
738     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
739     case BFD_RELOC_LO16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO;		break;
740     case BFD_RELOC_HI16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI;		break;
741     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA;		break;
742     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR14;		break;
743     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN;	break;
744     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
745     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26:		r = R_PPC_REL24;		break;
746     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16:		r = R_PPC_REL14;		break;
747     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN;	break;
748     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
749     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
750     case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16;		break;
751     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
752     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;		break;
753     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI;		break;
754     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF:	r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA;		break;
755     case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL24;		break;
756     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY:		r = R_PPC_COPY;			break;
757     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT:	r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT;		break;
758     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC:	r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC;		break;
759     case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL32;		break;
760     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT32;		break;
761     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL32;		break;
762     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
763     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO;		break;
764     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI;		break;
765     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF:	r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA;		break;
766     case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16:		r = R_PPC_SDAREL16;		break;
767     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
768     case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL:		r = R_PPC_SECTOFF;		break;
769     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
770     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO;		break;
771     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI;		break;
772     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA;		break;
773     case BFD_RELOC_CTOR:		r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
774     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
775     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16:		r = R_PPC_TOC16;		break;
776     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS:		r = R_PPC_TLS;			break;
777     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD:		r = R_PPC_TLSGD;		break;
778     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD:		r = R_PPC_TLSLD;		break;
779     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD:		r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32;		break;
780     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
781     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16:		r = R_PPC_TPREL16;		break;
782     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
783     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;		break;
784     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI;		break;
785     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;		break;
786     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL:		r = R_PPC_TPREL32;		break;
787     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
788     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16;		break;
789     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
790     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO;		break;
791     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI;		break;
792     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA;		break;
793     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL:		r = R_PPC_DTPREL32;		break;
794     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16;		break;
795     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO;	break;
796     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI;	break;
797     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA;	break;
798     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16;		break;
799     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO;	break;
800     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI;	break;
801     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA;	break;
802     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16;		break;
803     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO;	break;
804     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI;	break;
805     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA;	break;
806     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16;		break;
807     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO;	break;
808     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI;	break;
809     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA;	break;
810     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32;		break;
811     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16;		break;
812     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO;	break;
813     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI;	break;
814     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA;	break;
815     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16;		break;
816     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16;		break;
817     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL;		break;
818     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21;		break;
819     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:	r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF;		break;
820     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16;		break;
821     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO;		break;
822     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI;		break;
823     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA;		break;
824     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:	r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD;		break;
825     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA;		break;
826     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8;		break;
827     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15;		break;
828     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24;		break;
829     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A;		break;
830     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D;		break;
831     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A;		break;
832     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D;		break;
833     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A;		break;
834     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D;		break;
835     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21;		break;
836     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO;		break;
837     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
838       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
839       break;
840     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
841       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
842       break;
843     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
844       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
845       break;
846     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
847       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
848       break;
849     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
850       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
851       break;
852     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
853       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
854       break;
855     case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16;		break;
856     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_LO;		break;
857     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_HI;		break;
858     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_REL16_HA;		break;
859     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA:		r = R_PPC_16DX_HA;		break;
860     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA:	r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA;		break;
861     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT;	break;
862     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY;		break;
863     }
864 
865   return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
866 };
867 
868 static reloc_howto_type *
ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * r_name)869 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
870 			   const char *r_name)
871 {
872   unsigned int i;
873 
874   for (i = 0;
875        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
876        i++)
877     if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
878 	&& strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
879       return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
880 
881   return NULL;
882 }
883 
884 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc.  */
885 
886 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_info_to_howto(bfd * abfd,arelent * cache_ptr,Elf_Internal_Rela * dst)887 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
888 		       arelent *cache_ptr,
889 		       Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
890 {
891   unsigned int r_type;
892 
893   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
894   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
895     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
896 
897   r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
898   if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
899     {
900       /* xgettext:c-format */
901       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
902 			  abfd, r_type);
903       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
904       return FALSE;
905     }
906 
907   cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
908 
909   /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
910      ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation.  */
911   if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
912     {
913       /* xgettext:c-format */
914       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
915 			  abfd, r_type);
916       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
917 
918       return FALSE;
919     }
920 
921   return TRUE;
922 }
923 
924 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs.  */
925 
926 static bfd_reloc_status_type
ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)927 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
928 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
929 			 asymbol *symbol,
930 			 void *data,
931 			 asection *input_section,
932 			 bfd *output_bfd,
933 			 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
934 {
935   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
936   long insn;
937   bfd_size_type octets;
938   bfd_vma value;
939 
940   if (output_bfd != NULL)
941     {
942       reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
943       return bfd_reloc_ok;
944     }
945 
946   reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
947   r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
948   if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
949     return bfd_reloc_continue;
950 
951   value = 0;
952   if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
953     value = symbol->value;
954   value += (reloc_entry->addend
955 	    + symbol->section->output_offset
956 	    + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
957   value -= (reloc_entry->address
958 	    + input_section->output_offset
959 	    + input_section->output_section->vma);
960   value >>= 16;
961 
962   octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
963   insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
964   insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
965   insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
966   bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
967   return bfd_reloc_ok;
968 }
969 
970 static bfd_reloc_status_type
ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message)971 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
972 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
973 			 asymbol *symbol,
974 			 void *data,
975 			 asection *input_section,
976 			 bfd *output_bfd,
977 			 char **error_message)
978 {
979   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
980      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
981      link time.  */
982   if (output_bfd != NULL)
983     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
984 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
985 
986   if (error_message != NULL)
987     {
988       static char buf[60];
989       sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
990 	       reloc_entry->howto->name);
991       *error_message = buf;
992     }
993   return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
994 }
995 
996 /* Sections created by the linker.  */
997 
998 typedef struct elf_linker_section
999 {
1000   /* Pointer to the bfd section.  */
1001   asection *section;
1002   /* Section name.  */
1003   const char *name;
1004   /* Associated bss section name.  */
1005   const char *bss_name;
1006   /* Associated symbol name.  */
1007   const char *sym_name;
1008   /* Associated symbol.  */
1009   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1010 } elf_linker_section_t;
1011 
1012 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries.  This hangs off of the
1013    symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1014    based on different addend's.  */
1015 
1016 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1017 {
1018   /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1019   struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1020   /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1021   bfd_vma offset;
1022   /* addend used */
1023   bfd_vma addend;
1024   /* which linker section this is */
1025   elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1026 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1027 
1028 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1029 {
1030   struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1031 
1032   /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1033      sections added.  This is index by the symbol index.  */
1034   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1035 
1036   /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type.  */
1037   unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1038   unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1039 };
1040 
1041 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1042   ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1043 
1044 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1045   (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1046 
1047 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1048   (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1049    && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1050 
1051 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras.  */
1052 
1053 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_mkobject(bfd * abfd)1054 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1055 {
1056   return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1057 				  PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1058 }
1059 
1060 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match.  */
1061 
1062 bfd_boolean
_bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch(bfd * abfd)1063 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1064 {
1065   unsigned long mach = 0;
1066   asection *s;
1067   unsigned char *contents;
1068 
1069   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1070       && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1071     {
1072 
1073       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1074 	if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1075 	  break;
1076       if (s != NULL)
1077 	mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1078     }
1079 
1080   if (mach == 0)
1081     {
1082       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1083       if (s != NULL
1084 	  && s->size >= 24
1085 	  && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1086 	{
1087 	  unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1088 	  unsigned int i;
1089 
1090 	  for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1091 	    {
1092 	      unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1093 	      switch (val >> 16)
1094 		{
1095 		case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1096 		case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1097 		  if (mach == 0)
1098 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1099 		  break;
1100 
1101 		case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1102 		case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1103 		  if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1104 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1105 		  break;
1106 
1107 		case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1108 		case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1109 		case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1110 		  if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1111 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1112 		  break;
1113 
1114 		case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1115 		  mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1116 		  break;
1117 
1118 		default:
1119 		  mach = -1ul;
1120 		}
1121 	    }
1122 	  free (contents);
1123 	}
1124     }
1125 
1126   if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1127     {
1128       const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1129 
1130       for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1131 	if (arch->mach == mach)
1132 	  {
1133 	    abfd->arch_info = arch;
1134 	    break;
1135 	  }
1136     }
1137   return TRUE;
1138 }
1139 
1140 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1141    default is 64 bit.  Also select arch based on apuinfo.  */
1142 
1143 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_object_p(bfd * abfd)1144 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1145 {
1146   if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1147     return TRUE;
1148 
1149   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1150     {
1151       Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1152 
1153       if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1154 	{
1155 	  /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default.  */
1156 	  abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1157 	  BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1158 	}
1159     }
1160   return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1161 }
1162 
1163 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set.  */
1164 
1165 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_set_private_flags(bfd * abfd,flagword flags)1166 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1167 {
1168   BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1169 	      || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1170 
1171   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1172   elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1173   return TRUE;
1174 }
1175 
1176 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections.  */
1177 
1178 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_grok_prstatus(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Note * note)1179 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1180 {
1181   int offset;
1182   unsigned int size;
1183 
1184   switch (note->descsz)
1185     {
1186     default:
1187       return FALSE;
1188 
1189     case 268:		/* Linux/PPC.  */
1190       /* pr_cursig */
1191       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1192 
1193       /* pr_pid */
1194       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1195 
1196       /* pr_reg */
1197       offset = 72;
1198       size = 192;
1199 
1200       break;
1201     }
1202 
1203   /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
1204   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1205 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
1206 }
1207 
1208 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_grok_psinfo(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Note * note)1209 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1210 {
1211   switch (note->descsz)
1212     {
1213     default:
1214       return FALSE;
1215 
1216     case 128:		/* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo.  */
1217       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1218 	= bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1219       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1220 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1221       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1222 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1223     }
1224 
1225   /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1226      onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1227      implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
1228 
1229   {
1230     char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1231     int n = strlen (command);
1232 
1233     if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1234       command[n - 1] = '\0';
1235   }
1236 
1237   return TRUE;
1238 }
1239 
1240 static char *
ppc_elf_write_core_note(bfd * abfd,char * buf,int * bufsiz,int note_type,...)1241 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1242 {
1243   switch (note_type)
1244     {
1245     default:
1246       return NULL;
1247 
1248     case NT_PRPSINFO:
1249       {
1250 	char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1251 	va_list ap;
1252 
1253 	va_start (ap, note_type);
1254 	memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1255 	strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1256 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1257 	DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1258 	/* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1259 	   -Wstringop-truncation:
1260 	   https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1261 	 */
1262 	DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1263 #endif
1264 	strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1265 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1266 	DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1267 #endif
1268 	va_end (ap);
1269 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1270 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1271       }
1272 
1273     case NT_PRSTATUS:
1274       {
1275 	char data[268];
1276 	va_list ap;
1277 	long pid;
1278 	int cursig;
1279 	const void *greg;
1280 
1281 	va_start (ap, note_type);
1282 	memset (data, 0, 72);
1283 	pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1284 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1285 	cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1286 	bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1287 	greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1288 	memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1289 	memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1290 	va_end (ap);
1291 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1292 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1293       }
1294     }
1295 }
1296 
1297 static flagword
ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags(char * flag_name)1298 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1299 {
1300 
1301   if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1302     return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1303 
1304   return 0;
1305 }
1306 
1307 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1308    or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included.  */
1309 
1310 static bfd_vma
ppc_elf_plt_sym_val(bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const asection * plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const arelent * rel)1311 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1312 		     const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1313 		     const arelent *rel)
1314 {
1315   return rel->address;
1316 }
1317 
1318 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file.  This
1319    is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1320    type.  */
1321 
1322 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_section_from_shdr(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr,const char * name,int shindex)1323 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1324 			   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1325 			   const char *name,
1326 			   int shindex)
1327 {
1328   asection *newsect;
1329   flagword flags;
1330 
1331   if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1332     return FALSE;
1333 
1334   newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1335   flags = bfd_section_flags (newsect);
1336   if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1337     flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1338 
1339   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1340     flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1341 
1342   bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, flags);
1343   return TRUE;
1344 }
1345 
1346 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary.  */
1347 
1348 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_fake_sections(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,Elf_Internal_Shdr * shdr,asection * asect)1349 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1350 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1351 		       asection *asect)
1352 {
1353   if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1354     shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1355 
1356   return TRUE;
1357 }
1358 
1359 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1360    need to bump up the number of section headers.  */
1361 
1362 static int
ppc_elf_additional_program_headers(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1363 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1364 				    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1365 {
1366   asection *s;
1367   int ret = 0;
1368 
1369   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1370   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1371     ++ret;
1372 
1373   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1374   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1375     ++ret;
1376 
1377   return ret;
1378 }
1379 
1380 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables.  */
1381 
1382 bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_modify_segment_map(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1383 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1384 			    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1385 {
1386   struct elf_segment_map *m;
1387 
1388   /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1389      LMA and assigned to segments.  All that is left to do is to ensure
1390      there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1391      If we find that case, we split the segment.
1392      We maintain the original output section order.  */
1393 
1394   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1395     {
1396       struct elf_segment_map *n;
1397       bfd_size_type amt;
1398       unsigned int j, k;
1399       unsigned int p_flags;
1400 
1401       if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1402 	continue;
1403 
1404       for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1405 	{
1406 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1407 	    p_flags |= PF_W;
1408 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1409 	    {
1410 	      p_flags |= PF_X;
1411 	      if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1412 		p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1413 	      break;
1414 	    }
1415 	}
1416       if (j != m->count)
1417 	while (++j != m->count)
1418 	  {
1419 	    unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1420 
1421 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1422 	      p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1423 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1424 	      {
1425 		p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1426 		if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1427 		  p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1428 		if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1429 		  break;
1430 	      }
1431 	    p_flags |= p_flags1;
1432 	  }
1433       /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1434 	 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1435 	 two parts.  So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1436 	 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set.  */
1437       if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1438 	{
1439 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1440 	  m->p_flags = p_flags;
1441 	}
1442       if (j == m->count)
1443 	continue;
1444 
1445       /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1446 	 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1447 	 The scan resumes with the new segment.  */
1448 
1449       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1450       amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1451       n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1452       if (n == NULL)
1453 	return FALSE;
1454 
1455       n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1456       n->count = m->count - j;
1457       for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1458 	n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1459       m->count = j;
1460       m->p_size_valid = 0;
1461       n->next = m->next;
1462       m->next = n;
1463     }
1464 
1465   return TRUE;
1466 }
1467 
1468 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1469    .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1470    that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1471    2 sections.  */
1472 
1473 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1474 {
1475   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1476   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1477   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1478   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1479   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1480   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1481   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1482   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1483   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1484   { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1485 };
1486 
1487 /* This is what we want for new plt/got.  */
1488 static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1489   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"),		   0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1490 
1491 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)1492 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1493 {
1494   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1495 
1496   /* See if this is one of the special sections.  */
1497   if (sec->name == NULL)
1498     return NULL;
1499 
1500   ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1501 					sec->use_rela_p);
1502   if (ssect != NULL)
1503     {
1504       if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1505 	ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1506       return ssect;
1507     }
1508 
1509   return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1510 }
1511 
1512 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values.  */
1513 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1514 {
1515   struct apuinfo_list *next;
1516   unsigned long value;
1517 }
1518 apuinfo_list;
1519 
1520 static apuinfo_list *head;
1521 static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1522 
1523 static void
apuinfo_list_init(void)1524 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1525 {
1526   head = NULL;
1527   apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1528 }
1529 
1530 static void
apuinfo_list_add(unsigned long value)1531 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1532 {
1533   apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1534 
1535   while (entry != NULL)
1536     {
1537       if (entry->value == value)
1538 	return;
1539       entry = entry->next;
1540     }
1541 
1542   entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1543   if (entry == NULL)
1544     return;
1545 
1546   entry->value = value;
1547   entry->next  = head;
1548   head = entry;
1549 }
1550 
1551 static unsigned
apuinfo_list_length(void)1552 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1553 {
1554   apuinfo_list *entry;
1555   unsigned long count;
1556 
1557   for (entry = head, count = 0;
1558        entry;
1559        entry = entry->next)
1560     ++ count;
1561 
1562   return count;
1563 }
1564 
1565 static inline unsigned long
apuinfo_list_element(unsigned long number)1566 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1567 {
1568   apuinfo_list * entry;
1569 
1570   for (entry = head;
1571        entry && number --;
1572        entry = entry->next)
1573     ;
1574 
1575   return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1576 }
1577 
1578 static void
apuinfo_list_finish(void)1579 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1580 {
1581   apuinfo_list *entry;
1582 
1583   for (entry = head; entry;)
1584     {
1585       apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1586       free (entry);
1587       entry = next;
1588     }
1589 
1590   head = NULL;
1591 }
1592 
1593 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1594    the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted.  */
1595 
1596 static void
ppc_elf_begin_write_processing(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * link_info)1597 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1598 {
1599   bfd *ibfd;
1600   asection *asec;
1601   char *buffer = NULL;
1602   bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1603   unsigned i;
1604   unsigned long length;
1605   const char *error_message = NULL;
1606 
1607   if (link_info == NULL)
1608     return;
1609 
1610   apuinfo_list_init ();
1611 
1612   /* Read in the input sections contents.  */
1613   for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1614     {
1615       unsigned long datum;
1616 
1617       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1618       if (asec == NULL)
1619 	continue;
1620 
1621       /* xgettext:c-format */
1622       error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1623       length = asec->size;
1624       if (length < 20)
1625 	goto fail;
1626 
1627       apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1628       if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1629 	{
1630 	  if (buffer)
1631 	    free (buffer);
1632 	  largest_input_size = asec->size;
1633 	  buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1634 	  if (!buffer)
1635 	    return;
1636 	}
1637 
1638       if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1639 	  || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1640 	{
1641 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
1642 	  error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1643 	  goto fail;
1644 	}
1645 
1646       /* Verify the contents of the header.  Note - we have to
1647 	 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1648 	 host whose endian-ness is different from the target.  */
1649       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1650       if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1651 	goto fail;
1652 
1653       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1654       if (datum != 0x2)
1655 	goto fail;
1656 
1657       if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1658 	goto fail;
1659 
1660       /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries.  */
1661       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1662       if (datum + 20 != length)
1663 	goto fail;
1664 
1665       /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers.  */
1666       for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1667 	apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1668     }
1669 
1670   error_message = NULL;
1671 
1672   if (apuinfo_set)
1673     {
1674       /* Compute the size of the output section.  */
1675       unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1676 
1677       /* Set the output section size, if it exists.  */
1678       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1679 
1680       if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1681 	{
1682 	  ibfd = abfd;
1683 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
1684 	  error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1685 	}
1686     }
1687 
1688  fail:
1689   if (buffer)
1690     free (buffer);
1691 
1692   if (error_message)
1693     _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1694 }
1695 
1696 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1697    contents.  We have already stored this in our linked list structure.  */
1698 
1699 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_write_section(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * asec,bfd_byte * contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1700 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1701 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1702 		       asection *asec,
1703 		       bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1704 {
1705   return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1706 }
1707 
1708 /* Finally we can generate the output section.  */
1709 
1710 static void
ppc_final_write_processing(bfd * abfd)1711 ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1712 {
1713   bfd_byte *buffer;
1714   asection *asec;
1715   unsigned i;
1716   unsigned num_entries;
1717   bfd_size_type length;
1718 
1719   asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1720   if (asec == NULL)
1721     return;
1722 
1723   if (!apuinfo_set)
1724     return;
1725 
1726   length = asec->size;
1727   if (length < 20)
1728     return;
1729 
1730   buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1731   if (buffer == NULL)
1732     {
1733       _bfd_error_handler
1734 	(_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1735       return;
1736     }
1737 
1738   /* Create the apuinfo header.  */
1739   num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1740   bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1741   bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1742   bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1743   strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1744 
1745   length = 20;
1746   for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1747     {
1748       bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1749       length += 4;
1750     }
1751 
1752   if (length != asec->size)
1753     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1754 
1755   if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1756     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1757 
1758   free (buffer);
1759 
1760   apuinfo_list_finish ();
1761 }
1762 
1763 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_final_write_processing(bfd * abfd)1764 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1765 {
1766   ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1767   return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1768 }
1769 
1770 static bfd_boolean
is_nonpic_glink_stub(bfd * abfd,asection * glink,bfd_vma off)1771 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1772 {
1773   bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1774 
1775   if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1776     return FALSE;
1777 
1778   return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1779 	  && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1780 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1781 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1782 }
1783 
1784 static bfd_boolean
section_covers_vma(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * section,void * ptr)1785 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1786 {
1787   bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1788   return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1789 	  && section->vma <= vma
1790 	  && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1791 }
1792 
1793 static long
ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab(bfd * abfd,long symcount,asymbol ** syms,long dynsymcount,asymbol ** dynsyms,asymbol ** ret)1794 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1795 			      long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1796 			      asymbol **ret)
1797 {
1798   bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1799   asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1800   bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1801   bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1802   bfd_vma stub_off;
1803   asymbol *s;
1804   arelent *p;
1805   size_t count, i, stub_delta;
1806   size_t size;
1807   char *names;
1808   bfd_byte buf[4];
1809 
1810   *ret = NULL;
1811 
1812   if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1813     return 0;
1814 
1815   if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1816     return 0;
1817 
1818   relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1819   if (relplt == NULL)
1820     return 0;
1821 
1822   plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1823   if (plt == NULL)
1824     return 0;
1825 
1826   /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs.  */
1827   if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1828     return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1829 					  dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1830 
1831   /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1832      of .glink at got[1].  If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero.  */
1833   dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1834   if (dynamic != NULL)
1835     {
1836       bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1837       size_t extdynsize;
1838       void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1839 
1840       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1841 	return -1;
1842 
1843       extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1844       swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1845 
1846       extdyn = dynbuf;
1847       extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1848       for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1849 	{
1850 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1851 	  (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1852 
1853 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1854 	    break;
1855 
1856 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1857 	    {
1858 	      unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1859 	      asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1860 	      if (got != NULL
1861 		  && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1862 					       g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1863 		glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1864 	      break;
1865 	    }
1866 	}
1867       free (dynbuf);
1868     }
1869 
1870   /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry.  */
1871   if (glink_vma == 0)
1872     {
1873       if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1874 	glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1875     }
1876 
1877   if (glink_vma == 0)
1878     return 0;
1879 
1880   /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1881      link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1882      glink stubs now reside.  */
1883   glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1884   if (glink == NULL)
1885     return 0;
1886 
1887   /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1888      from the first glink stub.  */
1889   if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1890 				glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1891     {
1892       unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1893 
1894       /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ...  */
1895       insn ^= B;
1896       if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1897 	resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1898 
1899       /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs.  */
1900       else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1901 	for (i = 4;
1902 	     bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1903 				       glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1904 	     i += 4)
1905 	  if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1906 	    {
1907 	      resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1908 	      break;
1909 	    }
1910     }
1911 
1912   count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1913   /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1914      multiple stubs for each plt entry.  If that is the case then
1915      there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1916      of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1917      The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1918      GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
1919   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1920   for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1921     if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1922       break;
1923   if (stub_delta > 32)
1924     return 0;
1925 
1926   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1927   if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1928     return -1;
1929 
1930   size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1931   p = relplt->relocation;
1932   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1933     {
1934       size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1935       if (p->addend != 0)
1936 	size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1937     }
1938 
1939   size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1940 
1941   if (resolv_vma)
1942     size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1943 
1944   s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1945   if (s == NULL)
1946     return -1;
1947 
1948   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1949   names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1950   p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1951   for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1952     {
1953       size_t len;
1954 
1955       stub_off -= stub_delta;
1956       if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1957 	stub_off -= 32;
1958       *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1959       /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set.  Since
1960 	 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set.  */
1961       if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1962 	s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1963       s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1964       s->section = glink;
1965       s->value = stub_off;
1966       s->name = names;
1967       s->udata.p = NULL;
1968       len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1969       memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1970       names += len;
1971       if (p->addend != 0)
1972 	{
1973 	  memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1974 	  names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1975 	  bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1976 	  names += strlen (names);
1977 	}
1978       memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1979       names += sizeof ("@plt");
1980       ++s;
1981       --p;
1982     }
1983 
1984   /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table.  */
1985   memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1986   s->the_bfd = abfd;
1987   s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1988   s->section = glink;
1989   s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1990   s->name = names;
1991   memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
1992   names += sizeof ("__glink");
1993   s++;
1994   count++;
1995 
1996   if (resolv_vma)
1997     {
1998       /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver.  */
1999       memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2000       s->the_bfd = abfd;
2001       s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2002       s->section = glink;
2003       s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2004       s->name = names;
2005       memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2006       names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2007       s++;
2008       count++;
2009     }
2010 
2011   return count;
2012 }
2013 
2014 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2015    functions above are used generally.  They appear in this file more
2016    or less in the order in which they are called.  eg.
2017    ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2018    ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2019    called.  */
2020 
2021 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol.  We might need more
2022    than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary.  */
2023 struct plt_entry
2024 {
2025   struct plt_entry *next;
2026 
2027   /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2028      This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2029      GOT pointer reg.  It will always be at least 32768.  (Current
2030      gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2031      sections together resulting in larger offsets).  */
2032   bfd_vma addend;
2033 
2034   /* The .got2 section.  */
2035   asection *sec;
2036 
2037   /* PLT refcount or offset.  */
2038   union
2039     {
2040       bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2041       bfd_vma offset;
2042     } plt;
2043 
2044   /* .glink stub offset.  */
2045   bfd_vma glink_offset;
2046 };
2047 
2048 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2049    function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2050    library or PIE, even when the symbol is local.  */
2051 
2052 static int
must_be_dyn_reloc(struct bfd_link_info * info,enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)2053 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2054 		   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2055 {
2056   switch (r_type)
2057     {
2058     default:
2059       /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2060 	 address isn't fixed.  DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2061 	 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2062 	 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set.  */
2063       return 1;
2064 
2065     case R_PPC_REL24:
2066     case R_PPC_REL14:
2067     case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2068     case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2069     case R_PPC_REL32:
2070       return 0;
2071 
2072     case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2073     case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2074     case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2075     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2076     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2077       /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2078 	 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base.  */
2079       return bfd_link_dll (info);
2080     }
2081 }
2082 
2083 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2084    copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2085    section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2086    shared lib.  */
2087 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2088 
2089 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols.  */
2090 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2091 {
2092   struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2093 
2094   /* The input section of the reloc.  */
2095   asection *sec;
2096 
2097   /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section.  */
2098   unsigned int count : 31;
2099 
2100   /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols.  */
2101   unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2102 };
2103 
2104 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry.  */
2105 
2106 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2107 {
2108   struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2109 
2110   /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2111      specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2112      from the beginning of the section.  */
2113   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2114 
2115   /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol.  */
2116   struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
2117 
2118   /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2119      Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2120      encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2121      of the other TLS bits are set.  tls_optimize clears bits when
2122      optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2123      needed.  If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared.  tls_optimize may also
2124      set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2125      These flags are also kept for local symbols.  */
2126 #define TLS_TLS		 1	/* Any TLS reloc.  */
2127 #define TLS_GD		 2	/* GD reloc. */
2128 #define TLS_LD		 4	/* LD reloc. */
2129 #define TLS_TPREL	 8	/* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2130 #define TLS_DTPREL	16	/* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2131 #define TLS_MARK	32	/* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2132 #define TLS_GDIE	64	/* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2133   unsigned char tls_mask;
2134 
2135   /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols.  In which
2136      case TLS_TLS will be 0.  */
2137 #define PLT_IFUNC	 2	/* STT_GNU_IFUNC.  */
2138 #define PLT_KEEP	 4	/* inline plt call requires plt entry.  */
2139 #define NON_GOT        256	/* local symbol plt, not stored.  */
2140 
2141   /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2142      symbol.  */
2143   unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2144 
2145   /* Flag use of given relocations.  */
2146   unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2147   unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2148 };
2149 
2150 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2151 
2152 /* PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
2153 
2154 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2155 {
2156   struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2157 
2158   /* Various options passed from the linker.  */
2159   struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2160 
2161   /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections.  */
2162   asection *glink;
2163   asection *dynsbss;
2164   asection *relsbss;
2165   elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2166   asection *sbss;
2167   asection *glink_eh_frame;
2168   asection *pltlocal;
2169   asection *relpltlocal;
2170 
2171   /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks.  */
2172   asection *srelplt2;
2173 
2174   /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr.  */
2175   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2176 
2177   /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT.  */
2178   bfd *old_bfd;
2179 
2180   /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling.  */
2181   union {
2182     bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2183     bfd_vma offset;
2184   } tlsld_got;
2185 
2186   /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink.  */
2187   bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2188 
2189   /* Size of reserved GOT entries.  */
2190   unsigned int got_header_size;
2191   /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap.  */
2192   unsigned int got_gap;
2193 
2194   /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use.  */
2195   enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2196 
2197   /* True if the target system is VxWorks.  */
2198   unsigned int is_vxworks:1;
2199 
2200   /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2201      referenced by dynamic relocations.  */
2202   unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2203   unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2204 
2205   /* Set if tls optimization is enabled.  */
2206   unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2207 
2208   /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls.  */
2209   unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2210 
2211   /* The size of PLT entries.  */
2212   int plt_entry_size;
2213   /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots.  */
2214   int plt_slot_size;
2215   /* The size of the first PLT entry.  */
2216   int plt_initial_entry_size;
2217 
2218   /* Small local sym cache.  */
2219   struct sym_cache sym_cache;
2220 };
2221 
2222 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2223    are used for ppc32.  The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects.  */
2224 
2225 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations.  */
2226 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2227 
2228 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
2229    relocs.  */
2230 #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
2231 
2232   /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected.  */
2233 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2234 
2235 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
2236 
2237 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2238   (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
2239   == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
2240 
2241 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
2242 
2243 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc(struct bfd_hash_entry * entry,struct bfd_hash_table * table,const char * string)2244 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2245 			   struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2246 			   const char *string)
2247 {
2248   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2249      subclass.  */
2250   if (entry == NULL)
2251     {
2252       entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2253 				 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2254       if (entry == NULL)
2255 	return entry;
2256     }
2257 
2258   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
2259   entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2260   if (entry != NULL)
2261     {
2262       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2263       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2264       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2265       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2266     }
2267 
2268   return entry;
2269 }
2270 
2271 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
2272 
2273 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)2274 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2275 {
2276   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2277   static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2278     = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2279 
2280   ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2281   if (ret == NULL)
2282     return NULL;
2283 
2284   if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2285 				      ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2286 				      sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2287 				      PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2288     {
2289       free (ret);
2290       return NULL;
2291     }
2292 
2293   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2294   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2295   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2296   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2297 
2298   ret->params = &default_params;
2299 
2300   ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2301   ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2302   ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2303 
2304   ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2305   ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2306   ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2307 
2308   ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2309   ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2310   ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2311 
2312   return &ret->elf.root;
2313 }
2314 
2315 /* Hook linker params into hash table.  */
2316 
2317 void
ppc_elf_link_params(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct ppc_elf_params * params)2318 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2319 {
2320   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2321 
2322   if (htab)
2323     htab->params = params;
2324   params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2325 }
2326 
2327 /* Create .got and the related sections.  */
2328 
2329 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_create_got(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)2330 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2331 {
2332   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2333 
2334   if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2335     return FALSE;
2336 
2337   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2338   if (!htab->is_vxworks)
2339     {
2340       /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it.  Mark it
2341 	 executable.  */
2342       flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2343 			| SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2344       if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2345 	return FALSE;
2346     }
2347 
2348   return TRUE;
2349 }
2350 
2351 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2352    R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers.  These sections become part of .sdata
2353    and .sdata2.  Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too.  */
2354 
2355 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_create_linker_section(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,flagword flags,elf_linker_section_t * lsect)2356 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2357 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
2358 			       flagword flags,
2359 			       elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2360 {
2361   asection *s;
2362 
2363   flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2364 	    | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2365 
2366   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2367   if (s == NULL)
2368     return FALSE;
2369   lsect->section = s;
2370 
2371   /* Define the sym on the first section of this name.  */
2372   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2373 
2374   lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2375   if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2376     return FALSE;
2377   lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2378   return TRUE;
2379 }
2380 
2381 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_create_glink(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)2382 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2383 {
2384   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2385   asection *s;
2386   flagword flags;
2387   int p2align;
2388 
2389   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2390 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2391   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2392   htab->glink = s;
2393   p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2394   if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2395     p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2396   if (s == NULL
2397       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
2398     return FALSE;
2399 
2400   if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2401     {
2402       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2403 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2404       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2405       htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2406       if (s == NULL
2407 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2408 	return FALSE;
2409     }
2410 
2411   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2412   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2413   htab->elf.iplt = s;
2414   if (s == NULL
2415       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
2416     return FALSE;
2417 
2418   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2419 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2420   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2421   htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2422   if (s == NULL
2423       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2424     return FALSE;
2425 
2426   /* Local plt entries.  */
2427   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2428 	   | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2429   htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2430 						       flags);
2431   if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2432       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
2433     return FALSE;
2434 
2435   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2436     {
2437       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2438 	       | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2439       htab->relpltlocal
2440 	= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2441       if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2442 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2443 	return FALSE;
2444     }
2445 
2446   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2447 				      &htab->sdata[0]))
2448     return FALSE;
2449 
2450   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2451 				      &htab->sdata[1]))
2452     return FALSE;
2453 
2454   return TRUE;
2455 }
2456 
2457 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2458    to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2459    to create .dynbss and .rela.bss).  */
2460 
2461 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)2462 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2463 {
2464   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2465   asection *s;
2466   flagword flags;
2467 
2468   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2469 
2470   if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2471       && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2472     return FALSE;
2473 
2474   if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2475     return FALSE;
2476 
2477   if (htab->glink == NULL
2478       && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2479     return FALSE;
2480 
2481   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2482 					  SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2483   htab->dynsbss = s;
2484   if (s == NULL)
2485     return FALSE;
2486 
2487   if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2488     {
2489       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2490 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2491       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2492       htab->relsbss = s;
2493       if (s == NULL
2494 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2495 	return FALSE;
2496     }
2497 
2498   if (htab->is_vxworks
2499       && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2500     return FALSE;
2501 
2502   s = htab->elf.splt;
2503   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2504   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2505     /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents.  */
2506     flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2507   return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
2508 }
2509 
2510 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry.  */
2511 
2512 static void
ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * dir,struct elf_link_hash_entry * ind)2513 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2514 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2515 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2516 {
2517   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2518 
2519   edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2520   eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2521 
2522   edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2523   edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2524 
2525   if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2526     edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2527   edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2528   edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2529   edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2530   edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2531   edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2532 
2533   /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all.  */
2534   if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2535     return;
2536 
2537   if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2538     {
2539       if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2540 	{
2541 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2542 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2543 
2544 	  /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2545 	     list.  Merge any entries against the same section.  */
2546 	  for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2547 	    {
2548 	      struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2549 
2550 	      for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2551 		if (q->sec == p->sec)
2552 		  {
2553 		    q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2554 		    q->count += p->count;
2555 		    *pp = p->next;
2556 		    break;
2557 		  }
2558 	      if (q == NULL)
2559 		pp = &p->next;
2560 	    }
2561 	  *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
2562 	}
2563 
2564       edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
2565       eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2566     }
2567 
2568   /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2569      the symbol which just became indirect.  */
2570   edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2571   eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2572 
2573   /* And plt entries.  */
2574   if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2575     {
2576       if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2577 	{
2578 	  struct plt_entry **entp;
2579 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
2580 
2581 	  for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2582 	    {
2583 	      struct plt_entry *dent;
2584 
2585 	      for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2586 		if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2587 		  {
2588 		    dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2589 		    *entp = ent->next;
2590 		    break;
2591 		  }
2592 	      if (dent == NULL)
2593 		entp = &ent->next;
2594 	    }
2595 	  *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2596 	}
2597 
2598       edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2599       eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2600     }
2601 
2602   if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2603     {
2604       if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2605 	_bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2606 				edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2607       edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2608       edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2609       eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2610       eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2611     }
2612 }
2613 
2614 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2615    file.  We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss.  */
2616 
2617 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,const char ** namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,flagword * flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection ** secp,bfd_vma * valp)2618 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2619 			 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2620 			 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2621 			 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2622 			 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2623 			 asection **secp,
2624 			 bfd_vma *valp)
2625 {
2626   if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2627       && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2628       && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2629       && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2630     {
2631       /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2632 	 put into .sbss.  */
2633       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2634 
2635       htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2636       if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2637 	{
2638 	  flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2639 
2640 	  if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2641 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2642 
2643 	  htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2644 							   ".sbss",
2645 							   flags);
2646 	  if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2647 	    return FALSE;
2648 	}
2649 
2650       *secp = htab->sbss;
2651       *valp = sym->st_size;
2652     }
2653 
2654   return TRUE;
2655 }
2656 
2657 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type.  */
2658 
2659 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
elf_find_pointer_linker_section(elf_linker_section_pointers_t * linker_pointers,bfd_vma addend,elf_linker_section_t * lsect)2660 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2661   (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2662    bfd_vma addend,
2663    elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2664 {
2665   for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2666     if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2667       return linker_pointers;
2668 
2669   return NULL;
2670 }
2671 
2672 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section.  */
2673 
2674 static bfd_boolean
elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section(bfd * abfd,elf_linker_section_t * lsect,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rel)2675 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2676 				     elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2677 				     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2678 				     const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2679 {
2680   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2681   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2682   unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2683   bfd_size_type amt;
2684 
2685   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2686 
2687   /* Is this a global symbol?  */
2688   if (h != NULL)
2689     {
2690       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2691 
2692       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
2693       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2694       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2695 					   rel->r_addend,
2696 					   lsect))
2697 	return TRUE;
2698 
2699       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2700     }
2701   else
2702     {
2703       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2704 
2705       /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol.  */
2706       elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2707 
2708       /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time.  */
2709       if (!ptr)
2710 	{
2711 	  unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2712 
2713 	  amt = num_symbols;
2714 	  amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2715 	  ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2716 
2717 	  if (!ptr)
2718 	    return FALSE;
2719 
2720 	  elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2721 	}
2722 
2723       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
2724       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2725 					   rel->r_addend,
2726 					   lsect))
2727 	return TRUE;
2728 
2729       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2730     }
2731 
2732   /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2733      a new pointer record from internal memory.  */
2734   BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2735   amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2736   linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2737 
2738   if (!linker_section_ptr)
2739     return FALSE;
2740 
2741   linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2742   linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2743   linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2744   *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2745 
2746   if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
2747     return FALSE;
2748   linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2749   lsect->section->size += 4;
2750 
2751 #ifdef DEBUG
2752   fprintf (stderr,
2753 	   "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2754 	   lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2755 	   (long) lsect->section->size);
2756 #endif
2757 
2758   return TRUE;
2759 }
2760 
2761 static struct plt_entry **
update_local_sym_info(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * symtab_hdr,unsigned long r_symndx,int tls_type)2762 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2763 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2764 		       unsigned long r_symndx,
2765 		       int tls_type)
2766 {
2767   bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2768   struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2769   unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2770 
2771   if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2772     {
2773       bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2774 
2775       size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2776 	       + sizeof (*local_plt)
2777 	       + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2778       local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2779       if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2780 	return NULL;
2781       elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2782     }
2783 
2784   local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2785   local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2786   local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2787   if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2788     local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2789   return local_plt + r_symndx;
2790 }
2791 
2792 static bfd_boolean
update_plt_info(bfd * abfd,struct plt_entry ** plist,asection * sec,bfd_vma addend)2793 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2794 		 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2795 {
2796   struct plt_entry *ent;
2797 
2798   if (addend < 32768)
2799     sec = NULL;
2800   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2801     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2802       break;
2803   if (ent == NULL)
2804     {
2805       bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
2806       ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2807       if (ent == NULL)
2808 	return FALSE;
2809       ent->next = *plist;
2810       ent->sec = sec;
2811       ent->addend = addend;
2812       ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2813       *plist = ent;
2814     }
2815   ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2816   return TRUE;
2817 }
2818 
2819 static struct plt_entry *
find_plt_ent(struct plt_entry ** plist,asection * sec,bfd_vma addend)2820 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2821 {
2822   struct plt_entry *ent;
2823 
2824   if (addend < 32768)
2825     sec = NULL;
2826   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2827     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2828       break;
2829   return ent;
2830 }
2831 
2832 static bfd_boolean
is_branch_reloc(enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)2833 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2834 {
2835   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2836 	  || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2837 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2838 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2839 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2840 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2841 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2842 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2843 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2844 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2845 	  || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2846 }
2847 
2848 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call.  */
2849 
2850 static bfd_boolean
is_plt_seq_reloc(enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)2851 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2852 {
2853   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2854 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2855 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2856 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2857 }
2858 
2859 static void
bad_shared_reloc(bfd * abfd,enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)2860 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2861 {
2862   _bfd_error_handler
2863     /* xgettext:c-format */
2864     (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2865      abfd,
2866      ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2867   bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2868 }
2869 
2870 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2871    allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2872    table.  */
2873 
2874 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_check_relocs(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,asection * sec,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs)2875 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2876 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
2877 		      asection *sec,
2878 		      const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2879 {
2880   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2881   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2882   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2883   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2884   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2885   asection *got2, *sreloc;
2886   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2887 
2888   if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2889     return TRUE;
2890 
2891   /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
2892      In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
2893      and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
2894      or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
2895      relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
2896      libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate.  */
2897   if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2898     return TRUE;
2899 
2900 #ifdef DEBUG
2901   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2902 		      sec, abfd);
2903 #endif
2904 
2905   BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2906 
2907   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
2908   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2909     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2910 
2911   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2912   if (htab->glink == NULL)
2913     {
2914       if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2915 	htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2916       if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2917 	return FALSE;
2918     }
2919   tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2920 			      FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2921   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2922   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2923   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2924   sreloc = NULL;
2925 
2926   rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2927   for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2928     {
2929       unsigned long r_symndx;
2930       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2931       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2932       int tls_type;
2933       struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2934       struct plt_entry **pltent;
2935       bfd_vma addend;
2936 
2937       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2938       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2939 	h = NULL;
2940       else
2941 	{
2942 	  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2943 	  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2944 		 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2945 	    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2946 	}
2947 
2948       /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2949 	 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2950 	 startup code.  */
2951       if (h != NULL
2952 	  && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2953 	  && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2954 	{
2955 	  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2956 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2957 	  if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2958 	    return FALSE;
2959 	  BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2960 	}
2961 
2962       tls_type = 0;
2963       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2964       ifunc = NULL;
2965       if (h == NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
2966 	{
2967 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2968 							  abfd, r_symndx);
2969 	  if (isym == NULL)
2970 	    return FALSE;
2971 
2972 	  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2973 	    {
2974 	      /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet.  */
2975 	      ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2976 					     NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2977 	      if (ifunc == NULL)
2978 		return FALSE;
2979 
2980 	      /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2981 		 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2982 		 no plt calls.  */
2983 	      if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2984 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2985 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2986 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2987 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2988 		{
2989 		  addend = 0;
2990 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2991 		    ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2992 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2993 		      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2994 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2995 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2996 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2997 		    addend = rel->r_addend;
2998 		  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2999 		    return FALSE;
3000 		}
3001 	    }
3002 	}
3003 
3004       if (!htab->is_vxworks
3005 	  && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3006 	  && h != NULL
3007 	  && h == tga)
3008 	{
3009 	  if (rel != relocs
3010 	      && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3011 		  || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3012 	    /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3013 	       reloc.  */
3014 	    ;
3015 	  else
3016 	    /* Mark this section as having an old-style call.  */
3017 	    sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
3018 	}
3019 
3020       switch ((int)r_type)
3021 	{
3022 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3023 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3024 	  /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3025 	     its parameter symbol.  */
3026 	  if (h != NULL)
3027 	    ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3028 	  else
3029 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3030 					NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3031 	      return FALSE;
3032 	  break;
3033 
3034 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3035 	  break;
3036 
3037 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3038 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3039 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3040 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3041 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3042 	  goto dogottls;
3043 
3044 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3045 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3046 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3047 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3048 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3049 	  goto dogottls;
3050 
3051 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3052 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3053 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3054 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3055 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3056 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3057 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3058 	  goto dogottls;
3059 
3060 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3061 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3062 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3063 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3064 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3065 	dogottls:
3066 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3067 	  /* Fall through.  */
3068 
3069 	  /* GOT16 relocations */
3070 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
3071 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3072 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3073 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3074 	  /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry.  */
3075 	  if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3076 	    {
3077 	      if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3078 		htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3079 	      if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3080 		return FALSE;
3081 	    }
3082 	  if (h != NULL)
3083 	    {
3084 	      h->got.refcount += 1;
3085 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3086 	    }
3087 	  else
3088 	    /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol.  */
3089 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3090 	      return FALSE;
3091 
3092 	  /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3093 	     an ifunc.  */
3094 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3095 	    {
3096 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3097 		return FALSE;
3098 	    }
3099 	  break;
3100 
3101 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
3102 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3103 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3104 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3105 						    h, rel))
3106 	    return FALSE;
3107 	  if (h != NULL)
3108 	    {
3109 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3110 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3111 	    }
3112 	  break;
3113 
3114 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
3115 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3116 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3117 	    {
3118 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3119 	      return FALSE;
3120 	    }
3121 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3122 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3123 						    h, rel))
3124 	    return FALSE;
3125 	  if (h != NULL)
3126 	    {
3127 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3128 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3129 	    }
3130 	  break;
3131 
3132 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3133 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3134 	  /* Fall through.  */
3135 
3136 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3137 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3138 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3139 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3140 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3141 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3142 	  if (h != NULL)
3143 	    {
3144 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3145 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3146 	    }
3147 	  break;
3148 
3149 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3150 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3151 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3152 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3153 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3154 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3155 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3156 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3157 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3158 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3159 	  break;
3160 
3161 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3162 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3163 	    {
3164 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3165 	      return FALSE;
3166 	    }
3167 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3168 	  if (h != NULL)
3169 	    {
3170 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3171 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3172 	    }
3173 	  break;
3174 
3175 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3176 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3177 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3178 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3179 	  if (h != NULL)
3180 	    {
3181 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3182 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3183 	    }
3184 	  break;
3185 
3186 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3187 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3188 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3189 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3190 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3191 	  if (h != NULL)
3192 	    h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3193 	  break;
3194 
3195 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3196 	  if (h == NULL)
3197 	    break;
3198 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3199 	  goto pltentry;
3200 
3201 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3202 	  sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3203 	  /* Fall through.  */
3204 
3205 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
3206 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3207 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3208 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3209 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3210 	pltentry:
3211 #ifdef DEBUG
3212 	  fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3213 #endif
3214 	  /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry.  */
3215 	  if (h == NULL)
3216 	    {
3217 	      pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3218 					      NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3219 	      if (pltent == NULL)
3220 		return FALSE;
3221 	    }
3222 	  else
3223 	    {
3224 	      if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3225 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3226 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
3227 	      pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3228 	    }
3229 	  addend = 0;
3230 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3231 	      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3232 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3233 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3234 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3235 	    addend = rel->r_addend;
3236 	  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3237 	    return FALSE;
3238 	  break;
3239 
3240 	  /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3241 	     relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3242 	     section relative.  */
3243 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3244 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3245 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3246 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3247 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3248 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3249 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3250 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3251 	case R_PPC_TOC16:
3252 	  break;
3253 
3254 	case R_PPC_REL16:
3255 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3256 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3257 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3258 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3259 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3260 	  break;
3261 
3262 	  /* These are just markers.  */
3263 	case R_PPC_TLS:
3264 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3265 	case R_PPC_NONE:
3266 	case R_PPC_max:
3267 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
3268 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3269 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3270 	case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3271 	  break;
3272 
3273 	  /* These should only appear in dynamic objects.  */
3274 	case R_PPC_COPY:
3275 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3276 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3277 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3278 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3279 	  break;
3280 
3281 	  /* These aren't handled yet.  We'll report an error later.  */
3282 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3283 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3284 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3285 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3286 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3287 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3288 	  break;
3289 
3290 	  /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library.  */
3291 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3292 	  if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3293 	    {
3294 	      htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3295 	      htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3296 	    }
3297 	  if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3298 	    {
3299 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
3300 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3301 		return FALSE;
3302 	    }
3303 	  break;
3304 
3305 	  /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3306 	     Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
3307 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3308 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3309 	    return FALSE;
3310 	  break;
3311 
3312 	  /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3313 	     used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
3314 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3315 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3316 	    return FALSE;
3317 	  break;
3318 
3319 	  /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32.  */
3320 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3321 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3322 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3323 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3324 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3325 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3326 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3327 	  goto dodyn;
3328 
3329 	  /* Nor these.  */
3330 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3331 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3332 	  goto dodyn;
3333 
3334 	case R_PPC_REL32:
3335 	  if (h == NULL
3336 	      && got2 != NULL
3337 	      && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3338 	      && bfd_link_pic (info)
3339 	      && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3340 	    {
3341 	      /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3342 		 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3343 		 reference to .got2.  If we detect one of these, then
3344 		 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3345 		 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3346 		 PLT call stubs.  */
3347 	      asection *s;
3348 	      Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3349 
3350 	      isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3351 					    abfd, r_symndx);
3352 	      if (isym == NULL)
3353 		return FALSE;
3354 
3355 	      s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3356 	      if (s == got2)
3357 		{
3358 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3359 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3360 		}
3361 	    }
3362 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3363 	    break;
3364 	  /* fall through */
3365 
3366 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3367 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3368 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3369 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3370 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3371 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3372 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3373 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3374 	    {
3375 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3376 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
3377 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3378 		return FALSE;
3379 
3380 	      /* We may need a copy reloc too.  */
3381 	      h->non_got_ref = 1;
3382 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3383 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3384 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3385 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3386 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3387 	    }
3388 	  goto dodyn;
3389 
3390 	case R_PPC_REL24:
3391 	case R_PPC_REL14:
3392 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3393 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3394 	  if (h == NULL)
3395 	    break;
3396 	  if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3397 	    {
3398 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3399 		{
3400 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3401 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3402 		}
3403 	      break;
3404 	    }
3405 	  /* fall through */
3406 
3407 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3408 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3409 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3410 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3411 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3412 	    {
3413 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3414 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
3415 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
3416 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3417 		return FALSE;
3418 	      break;
3419 	    }
3420 
3421 	dodyn:
3422 	  /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3423 	     against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3424 	     against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3425 	     into the shared library.  However, if we are linking with
3426 	     -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3427 	     global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3428 	     including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set).  At
3429 	     this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3430 	     possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3431 	     later (it is never cleared).  In case of a weak definition,
3432 	     DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3433 	     a shared library.  We account for that possibility below by
3434 	     storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3435 	     table entry.  A similar situation occurs when creating
3436 	     shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3437 	     symbol local.
3438 
3439 	     If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3440 	     may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3441 	     dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3442 	     symbol.  */
3443 	  if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3444 	       && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3445 		   || (h != NULL
3446 		       && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3447 			   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3448 			   || !h->def_regular))))
3449 	      || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3450 		  && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3451 		  && h != NULL
3452 		  && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3453 		      || !h->def_regular)))
3454 	    {
3455 #ifdef DEBUG
3456 	      fprintf (stderr,
3457 		       "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3458 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
3459 		       (h && h->root.root.string
3460 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3461 #endif
3462 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
3463 		{
3464 		  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3465 		    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3466 
3467 		  sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3468 		    (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3469 
3470 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
3471 		    return FALSE;
3472 		}
3473 
3474 	      /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3475 		 relocations we need for this symbol.  */
3476 	      if (h != NULL)
3477 		{
3478 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3479 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3480 
3481 		  rel_head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
3482 		  p = *rel_head;
3483 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3484 		    {
3485 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3486 		      if (p == NULL)
3487 			return FALSE;
3488 		      p->next = *rel_head;
3489 		      *rel_head = p;
3490 		      p->sec = sec;
3491 		      p->count = 0;
3492 		      p->pc_count = 0;
3493 		    }
3494 		  p->count += 1;
3495 		  if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3496 		    p->pc_count += 1;
3497 		}
3498 	      else
3499 		{
3500 		  /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3501 		     We really need local syms available to do this
3502 		     easily.  Oh well.  */
3503 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3504 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3505 		  bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3506 		  asection *s;
3507 		  void *vpp;
3508 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3509 
3510 		  isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3511 						abfd, r_symndx);
3512 		  if (isym == NULL)
3513 		    return FALSE;
3514 
3515 		  s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3516 		  if (s == NULL)
3517 		    s = sec;
3518 
3519 		  vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3520 		  rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3521 		  is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3522 		  p = *rel_head;
3523 		  if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3524 		    p = p->next;
3525 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3526 		    {
3527 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3528 		      if (p == NULL)
3529 			return FALSE;
3530 		      p->next = *rel_head;
3531 		      *rel_head = p;
3532 		      p->sec = sec;
3533 		      p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3534 		      p->count = 0;
3535 		    }
3536 		  p->count += 1;
3537 		}
3538 	    }
3539 
3540 	  break;
3541 	}
3542     }
3543 
3544   return TRUE;
3545 }
3546 
3547 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3548    and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
3549 bfd_boolean
_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes(bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)3550 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3551 {
3552   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3553   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3554   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3555   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3556 
3557   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3558   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3559 
3560   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3561   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3562 
3563   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3564     {
3565       int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3566       int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3567       static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3568 
3569       if (in_fp == 0)
3570 	;
3571       else if (out_fp == 0)
3572 	{
3573 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3574 	  out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3575 	  last_fp = ibfd;
3576 	}
3577       else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3578 	{
3579 	  _bfd_error_handler
3580 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3581 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3582 	     last_fp, ibfd);
3583 	  ret = FALSE;
3584 	}
3585       else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3586 	{
3587 	  _bfd_error_handler
3588 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3589 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3590 	     ibfd, last_fp);
3591 	  ret = FALSE;
3592 	}
3593       else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3594 	{
3595 	  _bfd_error_handler
3596 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3597 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3598 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3599 	  ret = FALSE;
3600 	}
3601       else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3602 	{
3603 	  _bfd_error_handler
3604 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3605 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3606 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3607 	  ret = FALSE;
3608 	}
3609 
3610       in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3611       out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3612       if (in_fp == 0)
3613 	;
3614       else if (out_fp == 0)
3615 	{
3616 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3617 	  out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3618 	  last_ld = ibfd;
3619 	}
3620       else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3621 	{
3622 	  _bfd_error_handler
3623 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3624 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3625 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3626 	  ret = FALSE;
3627 	}
3628       else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3629 	{
3630 	  _bfd_error_handler
3631 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3632 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3633 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3634 	  ret = FALSE;
3635 	}
3636       else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3637 	{
3638 	  _bfd_error_handler
3639 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3640 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3641 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3642 	  ret = FALSE;
3643 	}
3644       else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3645 	{
3646 	  _bfd_error_handler
3647 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3648 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3649 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3650 	  ret = FALSE;
3651 	}
3652     }
3653 
3654   if (!ret)
3655     {
3656       out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3657       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3658     }
3659   return ret;
3660 }
3661 
3662 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD.  Warn if
3663    there are conflicting attributes.  */
3664 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes(bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)3665 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3666 {
3667   bfd *obfd;
3668   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3669   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3670   bfd_boolean ret;
3671 
3672   if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3673     return FALSE;
3674 
3675   obfd = info->output_bfd;
3676   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3677   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3678 
3679   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3680      merge non-conflicting ones.  */
3681   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3682   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3683   ret = TRUE;
3684   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3685     {
3686       int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3687       int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3688       static bfd *last_vec;
3689 
3690       if (in_vec == 0)
3691 	;
3692       else if (out_vec == 0)
3693 	{
3694 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3695 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
3696 	  last_vec = ibfd;
3697 	}
3698       /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3699 	 without a warning.  If GCC marked files with their stack
3700 	 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3701 	 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3702 	 case too.  */
3703       else if (in_vec == 1)
3704 	;
3705       else if (out_vec == 1)
3706 	{
3707 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3708 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
3709 	  last_vec = ibfd;
3710 	}
3711       else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3712 	{
3713 	  _bfd_error_handler
3714 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3715 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3716 	     last_vec, ibfd);
3717 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3718 	  ret = FALSE;
3719 	}
3720       else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3721 	{
3722 	  _bfd_error_handler
3723 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3724 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3725 	     ibfd, last_vec);
3726 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3727 	  ret = FALSE;
3728 	}
3729     }
3730 
3731   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3732      and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
3733   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3734   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3735   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3736     {
3737       int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3738       int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3739       static bfd *last_struct;
3740 
3741       if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3742        ;
3743       else if (out_struct == 0)
3744 	{
3745 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3746 	  out_attr->i = in_struct;
3747 	  last_struct = ibfd;
3748 	}
3749       else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3750 	{
3751 	  _bfd_error_handler
3752 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3753 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3754 	       "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3755 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3756 	  ret = FALSE;
3757 	}
3758       else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3759 	{
3760 	  _bfd_error_handler
3761 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3762 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3763 	       "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3764 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3765 	  ret = FALSE;
3766 	}
3767     }
3768   if (!ret)
3769     {
3770       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3771       return FALSE;
3772     }
3773 
3774   /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones.  */
3775   return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3776 }
3777 
3778 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3779    object file when linking.  */
3780 
3781 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data(bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)3782 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3783 {
3784   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3785   flagword old_flags;
3786   flagword new_flags;
3787   bfd_boolean error;
3788 
3789   if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3790     return TRUE;
3791 
3792   /* Check if we have the same endianness.  */
3793   if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3794     return FALSE;
3795 
3796   if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3797     return FALSE;
3798 
3799   new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3800   old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3801   if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3802     {
3803       /* First call, no flags set.  */
3804       elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3805       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3806     }
3807 
3808   /* Compatible flags are ok.  */
3809   else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3810     ;
3811 
3812   /* Incompatible flags.  */
3813   else
3814     {
3815       /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch.  Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3816 	 to be linked with either.  */
3817       error = FALSE;
3818       if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3819 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3820 	{
3821 	  error = TRUE;
3822 	  _bfd_error_handler
3823 	    (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3824 	       "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3825 	}
3826       else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3827 	       && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3828 	{
3829 	  error = TRUE;
3830 	  _bfd_error_handler
3831 	    (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3832 	       "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3833 	}
3834 
3835       /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are.  */
3836       if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3837 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3838 
3839       /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3840 	 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib.  */
3841       if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3842 	  && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3843 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3844 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3845 
3846       /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3847 	 any module uses it.  */
3848       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3849 
3850       new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3851       old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3852 
3853       /* Warn about any other mismatches.  */
3854       if (new_flags != old_flags)
3855 	{
3856 	  error = TRUE;
3857 	  _bfd_error_handler
3858 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
3859 	    (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3860 	       "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3861 	     ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3862 	}
3863 
3864       if (error)
3865 	{
3866 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3867 	  return FALSE;
3868 	}
3869     }
3870 
3871   return TRUE;
3872 }
3873 
3874 static void
ppc_elf_vle_split16(bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,unsigned long offset,bfd_byte * loc,bfd_vma value,split16_format_type split16_format,bfd_boolean fixup)3875 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3876 		     asection *input_section,
3877 		     unsigned long offset,
3878 		     bfd_byte *loc,
3879 		     bfd_vma value,
3880 		     split16_format_type split16_format,
3881 		     bfd_boolean fixup)
3882 {
3883   unsigned int insn, opcode;
3884 
3885   insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3886   opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3887   if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3888       || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3889       || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3890       || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3891       || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3892     {
3893       if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3894 	{
3895 	  if (fixup)
3896 	    split16_format = split16a_type;
3897 	  else
3898 	    _bfd_error_handler
3899 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
3900 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3901 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3902 	}
3903     }
3904   else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3905 	   || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3906 	   || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3907 	   || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3908 	   || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3909 	   || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3910 	   || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3911     {
3912       if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3913 	{
3914 	  if (fixup)
3915 	    split16_format = split16d_type;
3916 	  else
3917 	    _bfd_error_handler
3918 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
3919 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3920 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3921 	}
3922     }
3923   if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3924     {
3925       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3926       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3927       if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3928 	{
3929 	  /* Hack for e_li.  Extend sign.  */
3930 	  insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3931 	  insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3932 	}
3933     }
3934   else
3935     {
3936       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3937       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3938     }
3939   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3940   bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3941 }
3942 
3943 static void
ppc_elf_vle_split20(bfd * output_bfd,bfd_byte * loc,bfd_vma value)3944 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3945 {
3946   unsigned int insn;
3947 
3948   insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3949   /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
3950   /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
3951   insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3952   /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
3953   insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3954   /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
3955   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3956   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3957 }
3958 
3959 
3960 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3961    Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT.  */
3962 int
ppc_elf_select_plt_layout(bfd * output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,struct bfd_link_info * info)3963 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3964 			   struct bfd_link_info *info)
3965 {
3966   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3967   flagword flags;
3968 
3969   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3970 
3971   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3972     {
3973       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3974 
3975       if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3976 	htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3977       else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3978 	       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3979 	       && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3980 					     FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3981 	       && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3982 		   || h->needs_plt)
3983 	       && h->ref_regular
3984 	       && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3985 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3986 	{
3987 	  /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3988 	     secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3989 	     function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3990 	     r30 to be set up.  */
3991 	  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3992 	}
3993       else
3994 	{
3995 	  bfd *ibfd;
3996 	  enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
3997 
3998 	  /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
3999 	     Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4000 	     without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4001 	     --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs.  */
4002 	  if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4003 	    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4004 	  for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4005 	    if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4006 	      {
4007 		if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4008 		  plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4009 		else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4010 		  {
4011 		    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4012 		    htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4013 		    break;
4014 		  }
4015 	      }
4016 	  htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4017 	}
4018     }
4019   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4020     {
4021       if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4022 	_bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4023       else
4024 	_bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4025     }
4026 
4027   BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4028 
4029   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4030     {
4031       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4032 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4033 
4034       /* The new PLT is a loaded section.  */
4035       if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4036 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
4037 	return -1;
4038 
4039       /* The new GOT is not executable.  */
4040       if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4041 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4042 	return -1;
4043     }
4044   else
4045     {
4046       /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment.  */
4047       if (htab->glink != NULL
4048 	  && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
4049 	return -1;
4050     }
4051   return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4052 }
4053 
4054 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4055    relocation.  */
4056 
4057 static asection *
ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook(asection * sec,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)4058 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4059 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
4060 		      Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4061 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4062 		      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4063 {
4064   if (h != NULL)
4065     switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4066       {
4067       case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4068       case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4069 	return NULL;
4070       }
4071 
4072   return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4073 }
4074 
4075 static bfd_boolean
get_sym_h(struct elf_link_hash_entry ** hp,Elf_Internal_Sym ** symp,asection ** symsecp,unsigned char ** tls_maskp,Elf_Internal_Sym ** locsymsp,unsigned long r_symndx,bfd * ibfd)4076 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4077 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4078 	   asection **symsecp,
4079 	   unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4080 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4081 	   unsigned long r_symndx,
4082 	   bfd *ibfd)
4083 {
4084   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4085 
4086   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4087     {
4088       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4089       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4090 
4091       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4092       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4093 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4094 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4095 
4096       if (hp != NULL)
4097 	*hp = h;
4098 
4099       if (symp != NULL)
4100 	*symp = NULL;
4101 
4102       if (symsecp != NULL)
4103 	{
4104 	  asection *symsec = NULL;
4105 	  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4106 	      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4107 	    symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4108 	  *symsecp = symsec;
4109 	}
4110 
4111       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4112 	*tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4113     }
4114   else
4115     {
4116       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4117       Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4118 
4119       if (locsyms == NULL)
4120 	{
4121 	  locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4122 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
4123 	    locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4124 					    symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4125 					    0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4126 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
4127 	    return FALSE;
4128 	  *locsymsp = locsyms;
4129 	}
4130       sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4131 
4132       if (hp != NULL)
4133 	*hp = NULL;
4134 
4135       if (symp != NULL)
4136 	*symp = sym;
4137 
4138       if (symsecp != NULL)
4139 	*symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4140 
4141       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4142 	{
4143 	  bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4144 	  unsigned char *tls_mask;
4145 
4146 	  tls_mask = NULL;
4147 	  local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4148 	  if (local_got != NULL)
4149 	    {
4150 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4151 		(local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4152 	      unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4153 		(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4154 	      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4155 	    }
4156 	  *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4157 	}
4158     }
4159   return TRUE;
4160 }
4161 
4162 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4163    defined functions can be converted to direct calls.  */
4164 
4165 bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_inline_plt(struct bfd_link_info * info)4166 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4167 {
4168   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4169   bfd *ibfd;
4170   asection *sec;
4171   bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4172 
4173   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4174   if (htab == NULL)
4175     return FALSE;
4176 
4177   /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc.  The limit is
4178      reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4179      between the call and its destination.  */
4180   limit = 0x1e00000;
4181   low_vma = -1;
4182   high_vma = 0;
4183   for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4184     if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4185       {
4186 	if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4187 	  low_vma = sec->vma;
4188 	if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4189 	  high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4190       }
4191 
4192   /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4193      convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4194      is local.  */
4195   if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4196     {
4197       htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4198       return TRUE;
4199     }
4200 
4201   /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4202      call won't reach.  Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4203      the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4204      this will be better than creating trampolines.  Note that this
4205      will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4206      particular symbol, not just those that won't reach.  The
4207      difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4208      linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4209      particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4210      call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4211      the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4212      together except their symbol.  */
4213 
4214   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4215     {
4216       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4217       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4218 
4219       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4220 	continue;
4221 
4222       local_syms = NULL;
4223       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4224 
4225       for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4226 	if (sec->has_pltcall
4227 	    && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4228 	  {
4229 	    Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4230 
4231 	    /* Read the relocations.  */
4232 	    relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4233 						  info->keep_memory);
4234 	    if (relstart == NULL)
4235 	      return FALSE;
4236 
4237 	    relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4238 	    for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4239 	      {
4240 		enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4241 		unsigned long r_symndx;
4242 		asection *sym_sec;
4243 		struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4244 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4245 		unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4246 
4247 		r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4248 		if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4249 		  continue;
4250 
4251 		r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4252 		if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4253 				r_symndx, ibfd))
4254 		  {
4255 		    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4256 		      free (relstart);
4257 		    if (local_syms != NULL
4258 			&& symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4259 		      free (local_syms);
4260 		    return FALSE;
4261 		  }
4262 
4263 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4264 		  {
4265 		    bfd_vma from, to;
4266 		    if (h != NULL)
4267 		      to = h->root.u.def.value;
4268 		    else
4269 		      to = sym->st_value;
4270 		    to += (rel->r_addend
4271 			   + sym_sec->output_offset
4272 			   + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4273 		    from = (rel->r_offset
4274 			    + sec->output_offset
4275 			    + sec->output_section->vma);
4276 		    if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4277 		      *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4278 		  }
4279 	      }
4280 	    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4281 	      free (relstart);
4282 	  }
4283 
4284       if (local_syms != NULL
4285 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4286 	{
4287 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
4288 	    free (local_syms);
4289 	  else
4290 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4291 	}
4292     }
4293 
4294   return TRUE;
4295 }
4296 
4297 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4298    generic ELF tls_setup function.  */
4299 
4300 asection *
ppc_elf_tls_setup(bfd * obfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)4301 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4302 {
4303   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4304 
4305   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4306   htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4307 					     FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4308   if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4309     htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4310 
4311   if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4312     {
4313       struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4314       opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4315 				  FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4316       if (opt != NULL
4317 	  && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4318 	      || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4319 	{
4320 	  /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4321 	     signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4322 	     be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4323 	     make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
4324 	  tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4325 	  if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4326 	      && tga != NULL
4327 	      && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4328 		  || tga->needs_plt)
4329 	      && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4330 		   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4331 	    {
4332 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
4333 	      for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4334 		if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4335 		  break;
4336 	      if (ent != NULL)
4337 		{
4338 		  tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4339 		  tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4340 		  ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4341 		  opt->mark = 1;
4342 		  if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4343 		    {
4344 		      /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations.  */
4345 		      opt->dynindx = -1;
4346 		      _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4347 					      opt->dynstr_index);
4348 		      if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4349 			return FALSE;
4350 		    }
4351 		  htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4352 		}
4353 	    }
4354 	}
4355       else
4356 	htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4357     }
4358   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4359       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4360       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4361     {
4362       elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4363       elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4364     }
4365 
4366   return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4367 }
4368 
4369 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4370    HASH.  */
4371 
4372 static bfd_boolean
branch_reloc_hash_match(const bfd * ibfd,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,const struct elf_link_hash_entry * hash)4373 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4374 			 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4375 			 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4376 {
4377   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4378   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4379   unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4380 
4381   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4382     {
4383       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4384       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4385 
4386       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4387       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4388 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4389 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4390       if (h == hash)
4391 	return TRUE;
4392     }
4393   return FALSE;
4394 }
4395 
4396 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4397    opportunities.  */
4398 
4399 bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_tls_optimize(bfd * obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,struct bfd_link_info * info)4400 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4401 		      struct bfd_link_info *info)
4402 {
4403   bfd *ibfd;
4404   asection *sec;
4405   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4406   int pass;
4407 
4408   if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4409     return TRUE;
4410 
4411   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4412   if (htab == NULL)
4413     return FALSE;
4414 
4415   /* Make two passes through the relocs.  First time check that tls
4416      relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4417      followed by such a call.  If they are not, don't do any tls
4418      optimization.  On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4419      notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4420      adjust got and plt refcounts.  */
4421   for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4422     for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4423       {
4424 	Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4425 	asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4426 
4427 	for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4428 	  if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4429 	    {
4430 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4431 	      int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4432 
4433 	      /* Read the relocations.  */
4434 	      relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4435 						    info->keep_memory);
4436 	      if (relstart == NULL)
4437 		return FALSE;
4438 
4439 	      relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4440 	      for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4441 		{
4442 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4443 		  unsigned long r_symndx;
4444 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4445 		  unsigned char *tls_mask;
4446 		  unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4447 		  bfd_boolean is_local;
4448 		  bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4449 
4450 		  r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4451 		  if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4452 		    {
4453 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4454 
4455 		      sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4456 		      h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4457 		      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4458 			     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4459 			h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4460 		    }
4461 
4462 		  is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
4463 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4464 		  /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4465 		     without marker relocs, then check that each
4466 		     __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4467 		     that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4468 		     setup insn.  If we don't find matching arg setup
4469 		     relocs, don't do any tls optimization.  */
4470 		  if (pass == 0
4471 		      && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4472 		      && h != NULL
4473 		      && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4474 		      && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4475 		      && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4476 		    {
4477 		      info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4478 					      "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4479 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4480 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4481 			free (relstart);
4482 		      return TRUE;
4483 		    }
4484 
4485 		  expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4486 		  switch (r_type)
4487 		    {
4488 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4489 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4490 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4491 		      /* Fall through.  */
4492 
4493 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4494 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4495 		      /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4496 			 defined in a shared lib.  Leave them alone if
4497 			 that turns out to be the case.  */
4498 		      if (!is_local)
4499 			continue;
4500 
4501 		      /* LD -> LE */
4502 		      tls_set = 0;
4503 		      tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4504 		      break;
4505 
4506 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4507 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4508 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4509 		      /* Fall through.  */
4510 
4511 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4512 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4513 		      if (is_local)
4514 			/* GD -> LE */
4515 			tls_set = 0;
4516 		      else
4517 			/* GD -> IE */
4518 			tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4519 		      tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4520 		      break;
4521 
4522 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4523 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4524 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4525 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4526 		      if (is_local)
4527 			{
4528 			  /* IE -> LE */
4529 			  tls_set = 0;
4530 			  tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4531 			  break;
4532 			}
4533 		      else
4534 			continue;
4535 
4536 		    case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4537 		      if (!is_local)
4538 			continue;
4539 		      /* Fall through.  */
4540 		    case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4541 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
4542 			  && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4543 			{
4544 			  if (pass != 0
4545 			      && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4546 			    {
4547 			      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4548 			      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4549 			      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4550 				{
4551 				  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4552 
4553 				  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4554 				  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4555 				  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4556 					 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4557 				    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4558 				  if (h != NULL)
4559 				    {
4560 				      struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4561 				      bfd_vma addend = 0;
4562 
4563 				      if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4564 					addend = rel->r_addend;
4565 				      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4566 							  got2, addend);
4567 				      if (ent != NULL
4568 					  && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4569 					ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4570 				    }
4571 				}
4572 			    }
4573 			  continue;
4574 			}
4575 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4576 		      tls_set = 0;
4577 		      tls_clear = 0;
4578 		      break;
4579 
4580 		    default:
4581 		      continue;
4582 		    }
4583 
4584 		  if (pass == 0)
4585 		    {
4586 		      if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4587 			  || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4588 			continue;
4589 
4590 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
4591 			  && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4592 						      htab->tls_get_addr))
4593 			continue;
4594 
4595 		      /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call.  We
4596 			 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4597 			 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4598 			 the entire optimization.  */
4599 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4600 						"TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4601 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4602 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4603 			free (relstart);
4604 		      return TRUE;
4605 		    }
4606 
4607 		  if (h != NULL)
4608 		    {
4609 		      tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4610 		      got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4611 		    }
4612 		  else
4613 		    {
4614 		      bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4615 		      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4616 		      unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4617 
4618 		      lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4619 		      if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4620 			abort ();
4621 		      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4622 			(lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4623 		      lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4624 			(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4625 		      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4626 		      got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4627 		    }
4628 
4629 		  /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4630 		     without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4631 		     found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4632 		     marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4633 		     broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4634 		     indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4635 		     Disable optimization in this case.  */
4636 		  if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4637 		      && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4638 		      && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4639 			  != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4640 		    continue;
4641 
4642 		  if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4643 		    {
4644 		      struct plt_entry *ent;
4645 		      bfd_vma addend = 0;
4646 
4647 		      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4648 			  && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4649 			      || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4650 			addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4651 		      ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4652 					  got2, addend);
4653 		      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4654 			ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4655 		    }
4656 		  if (tls_clear == 0)
4657 		    continue;
4658 
4659 		  if (tls_set == 0)
4660 		    {
4661 		      /* We managed to get rid of a got entry.  */
4662 		      if (*got_count > 0)
4663 			*got_count -= 1;
4664 		    }
4665 
4666 		  *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4667 		  *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4668 		}
4669 
4670 	      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4671 		free (relstart);
4672 	    }
4673       }
4674   htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4675   return TRUE;
4676 }
4677 
4678 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections.  */
4679 
4680 static asection *
readonly_dynrelocs(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)4681 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4682 {
4683   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4684 
4685   for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4686     {
4687       asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
4688 
4689       if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4690 	return p->sec;
4691     }
4692   return NULL;
4693 }
4694 
4695 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4696    aliases, that apply to read-only sections.  Cannot be used after
4697    size_dynamic_sections.  */
4698 
4699 static bfd_boolean
alias_readonly_dynrelocs(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)4700 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4701 {
4702   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4703   do
4704     {
4705       if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4706 	return TRUE;
4707       eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4708     } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4709 
4710   return FALSE;
4711 }
4712 
4713 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs.  */
4714 
4715 static bfd_boolean
pc_dynrelocs(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)4716 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4717 {
4718   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4719 
4720   for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4721     if (p->pc_count != 0)
4722       return TRUE;
4723   return FALSE;
4724 }
4725 
4726 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4727    regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
4728    dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
4729    change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4730    understand.  */
4731 
4732 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)4733 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4734 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4735 {
4736   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4737   asection *s;
4738 
4739 #ifdef DEBUG
4740   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4741 	   h->root.root.string);
4742 #endif
4743 
4744   /* Make sure we know what is going on here.  */
4745   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4746   BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4747 	      && (h->needs_plt
4748 		  || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4749 		  || h->is_weakalias
4750 		  || (h->def_dynamic
4751 		      && h->ref_regular
4752 		      && !h->def_regular)));
4753 
4754   /* Deal with function syms.  */
4755   if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4756       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4757       || h->needs_plt)
4758     {
4759       bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4760 			   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4761       /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4762 	 function symbol is local.  */
4763       if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4764 	ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4765 
4766       /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4767 	 won't need a .plt entry.  */
4768       struct plt_entry *ent;
4769       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4770 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4771 	  break;
4772       if (ent == NULL
4773 	  || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4774 	      && local
4775 	      && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4776 		  || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4777 		      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4778 	{
4779 	  /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4780 
4781 	     1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4782 	     can't be set up, so we can't use one.  In this case,
4783 	     ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4784 
4785 	     2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4786 
4787 	     3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4788 	     will go to this object, or will remain undefined.  */
4789 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
4790 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
4791 	  h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4792 	}
4793       else
4794 	{
4795 	  /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4796 	     doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4797 	     executable on a plt call stub.  A dynamic reloc can
4798 	     be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4799 	     (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4800 	     through the plt call stub.)  Similarly, use a dynamic
4801 	     reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4802 	     resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4803 	     than link time.  */
4804 	  if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4805 	       || (h->non_got_ref
4806 		   && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4807 		   && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4808 	      && !htab->is_vxworks
4809 	      && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4810 	      && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4811 	    {
4812 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4813 	      /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4814 		 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry.  */
4815 	      if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4816 		h->plt.plist = NULL;
4817 	    }
4818 	  else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4819 	    /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4820 	       plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic.  */
4821 	    ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4822 	}
4823       h->protected_def = 0;
4824       /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs.  */
4825       return TRUE;
4826     }
4827   else
4828     h->plt.plist = NULL;
4829 
4830   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4831      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4832      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
4833   if (h->is_weakalias)
4834     {
4835       struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4836       BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4837       h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4838       h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4839       if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4840 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4841 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4842 	ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4843       return TRUE;
4844     }
4845 
4846   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4847      is not a function.  */
4848 
4849   /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4850      only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4851      For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4852      be handled correctly by relocate_section.  */
4853   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4854     {
4855       h->protected_def = 0;
4856       return TRUE;
4857     }
4858 
4859   /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4860      GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc.  */
4861   if (!h->non_got_ref)
4862     {
4863       h->protected_def = 0;
4864       return TRUE;
4865     }
4866 
4867   /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss.  The copy in
4868      .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4869      definition for the variable.  Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4870      are preferable to an incorrect program.  */
4871   if (h->protected_def)
4872     {
4873       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4874 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4875 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4876 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4877 	  && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4878 	htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4879       return TRUE;
4880     }
4881 
4882   /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either.  */
4883   if (info->nocopyreloc)
4884     return TRUE;
4885 
4886    /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4887       we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4888       We can't do this if there are any small data relocations.  This
4889       doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4890       relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4891       executable.  */
4892   if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4893       && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4894       && !htab->is_vxworks
4895       && !h->def_regular
4896       && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4897     return TRUE;
4898 
4899   /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4900      become part of the .bss section of the executable.  There will be
4901      an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section.  The dynamic
4902      object will contain position independent code, so all references
4903      from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4904      offset table.  The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4905      determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4906      both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4907      same memory location for the variable.
4908 
4909      Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4910      must instead allocate it in .sbss.  */
4911   if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4912     s = htab->dynsbss;
4913   else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4914     s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4915   else
4916     s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4917   BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4918 
4919   if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4920     {
4921       asection *srel;
4922 
4923       /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4924 	 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4925 	 and into the runtime process image.  */
4926       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4927 	srel = htab->relsbss;
4928       else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4929 	srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4930       else
4931 	srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4932       BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4933       srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4934       h->needs_copy = 1;
4935     }
4936 
4937   /* We no longer want dyn_relocs.  */
4938   ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4939   return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4940 }
4941 
4942 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs.  For non-PIC code the sym is
4943    xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4944    specifying the addend on the plt relocation.  For -fpic code, the sym
4945    is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4946    xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>.  */
4947 
4948 static bfd_boolean
add_stub_sym(struct plt_entry * ent,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,struct bfd_link_info * info)4949 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4950 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4951 	      struct bfd_link_info *info)
4952 {
4953   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4954   size_t len1, len2, len3;
4955   char *name;
4956   const char *stub;
4957   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4958 
4959   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4960     stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4961   else
4962     stub = ".plt_call32.";
4963 
4964   len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4965   len2 = strlen (stub);
4966   len3 = 0;
4967   if (ent->sec)
4968     len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4969   name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4970   if (name == NULL)
4971     return FALSE;
4972   sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4973   if (ent->sec)
4974     memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4975   memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4976   memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4977   sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
4978   if (sh == NULL)
4979     return FALSE;
4980   if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
4981     {
4982       sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
4983       sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
4984       sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
4985       sh->ref_regular = 1;
4986       sh->def_regular = 1;
4987       sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
4988       sh->forced_local = 1;
4989       sh->non_elf = 0;
4990       sh->root.linker_def = 1;
4991     }
4992   return TRUE;
4993 }
4994 
4995 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
4996    Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k.  */
4997 
4998 static bfd_vma
allocate_got(struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table * htab,unsigned int need)4999 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
5000 {
5001   bfd_vma where;
5002   unsigned int max_before_header;
5003 
5004   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5005     {
5006       where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5007       htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5008     }
5009   else
5010     {
5011       max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5012       if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5013 	{
5014 	  where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5015 	  htab->got_gap -= need;
5016 	}
5017       else
5018 	{
5019 	  if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5020 	      && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5021 	    {
5022 	      htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5023 	      htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5024 	    }
5025 	  where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5026 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5027 	}
5028     }
5029   return where;
5030 }
5031 
5032 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5033    TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot.  */
5034 
5035 static inline unsigned int
got_entries_needed(int tls_mask)5036 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5037 {
5038   unsigned int need;
5039   if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5040     need = 4;
5041   else
5042     {
5043       need = 0;
5044       if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5045 	need += 8;
5046       if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5047 	need += 4;
5048       if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5049 	need += 4;
5050     }
5051   return need;
5052 }
5053 
5054 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense.  */
5055 
5056 static bfd_boolean
ensure_undef_dynamic(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)5057 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5058 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5059 {
5060   struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5061 
5062   if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5063       && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5064 	   && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5065 	  || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5066       && h->dynindx == -1
5067       && !h->forced_local
5068       && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5069     return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5070   return TRUE;
5071 }
5072 
5073 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs.  */
5074 
5075 static bfd_boolean
allocate_dynrelocs(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * inf)5076 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5077 {
5078   struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5079   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5080   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5081   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5082   bfd_boolean dyn;
5083 
5084   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5085     return TRUE;
5086 
5087   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5088   eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5089   if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5090       || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5091 	  && !eh->elf.def_regular
5092 	  && eh->elf.protected_def
5093 	  && eh->has_addr16_ha
5094 	  && eh->has_addr16_lo
5095 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5096     {
5097       unsigned int need;
5098 
5099       /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
5100       if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5101 	return FALSE;
5102 
5103       need = 0;
5104       if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5105 	{
5106 	  if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5107 	    /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset.  This should
5108 	       always be the case.  It's a little odd if we have
5109 	       a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol.  */
5110 	    htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5111 	  else
5112 	    need += 8;
5113 	}
5114       need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5115       if (need == 0)
5116 	eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5117       else
5118 	{
5119 	  eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5120 	  if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
5121 		&& !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5122 		     && bfd_link_executable (info)
5123 		     && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5124 	       || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5125 		   && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5126 		   && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5127 	      && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5128 	    {
5129 	      asection *rsec;
5130 
5131 	      need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5132 	      if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5133 		need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5134 	      rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5135 	      if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5136 		rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5137 	      rsec->size += need;
5138 	    }
5139 	}
5140     }
5141   else
5142     eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5143 
5144   /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5145      IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables.  */
5146   if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5147       && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5148     eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5149 
5150   /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local.  */
5151   else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5152 	   && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5153     eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5154 
5155   /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5156      visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so.  */
5157   else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5158     eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5159 
5160   if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5161     ;
5162 
5163   /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5164      dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5165      defined in regular objects.  For the normal shared case, discard
5166      space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5167      changes.  */
5168   else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5169     {
5170       /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5171 	 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5172 	 generated via assembly.  We want calls to protected symbols to
5173 	 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5174 	 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5175 	 then they should avoid writing weird assembly.  */
5176       if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5177 	{
5178 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5179 
5180 	  for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5181 	    {
5182 	      p->count -= p->pc_count;
5183 	      p->pc_count = 0;
5184 	      if (p->count == 0)
5185 		*pp = p->next;
5186 	      else
5187 		pp = &p->next;
5188 	    }
5189 	}
5190 
5191       if (htab->is_vxworks)
5192 	{
5193 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5194 
5195 	  for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5196 	    {
5197 	      if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5198 		*pp = p->next;
5199 	      else
5200 		pp = &p->next;
5201 	    }
5202 	}
5203 
5204       if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5205 	{
5206 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
5207 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5208 	    return FALSE;
5209 	}
5210     }
5211   else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5212     {
5213       /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5214 	 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5215 	 dynamic.  */
5216       if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5217 	  && !h->def_regular
5218 	  && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5219 	  && !(h->protected_def
5220 	       && eh->has_addr16_ha
5221 	       && eh->has_addr16_lo
5222 	       && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5223 	{
5224 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
5225 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5226 	    return FALSE;
5227 
5228 	  if (h->dynindx == -1)
5229 	    eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5230 	}
5231       else
5232 	eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5233     }
5234 
5235   /* Allocate space.  */
5236   for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5237     {
5238       asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5239       if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5240 	sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5241       sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5242     }
5243 
5244   /* Handle PLT relocs.  Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5245      We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5246      a) is dynamic, or
5247      b) is an ifunc, or
5248      c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5249      d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically.  */
5250   dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5251   if (dyn
5252       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5253       || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5254       || (h->needs_plt
5255 	  && h->def_regular
5256 	  && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5257 	  && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5258 	  && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5259 	      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5260     {
5261       struct plt_entry *ent;
5262       bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5263       bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5264 
5265       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5266 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5267 	  {
5268 	    asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5269 
5270 	    if (!dyn)
5271 	      {
5272 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5273 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
5274 		else
5275 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
5276 	      }
5277 
5278 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5279 	      {
5280 		if (!doneone)
5281 		  {
5282 		    plt_offset = s->size;
5283 		    s->size += 4;
5284 		  }
5285 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5286 
5287 		if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5288 		  ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5289 		else
5290 		  {
5291 		    s = htab->glink;
5292 		    if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5293 		      {
5294 			glink_offset = s->size;
5295 			s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5296 		      }
5297 		    if (!doneone
5298 			&& !bfd_link_pic (info)
5299 			&& h->def_dynamic
5300 			&& !h->def_regular)
5301 		      {
5302 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
5303 			h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5304 		      }
5305 		    ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5306 
5307 		    if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5308 			&& !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5309 		      return FALSE;
5310 		  }
5311 	      }
5312 	    else
5313 	      {
5314 		if (!doneone)
5315 		  {
5316 		    /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5317 		       for the special first entry.  */
5318 		    if (s->size == 0)
5319 		      s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5320 
5321 		    /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5322 		       parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5323 		       and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5324 		       word available at the end.  */
5325 		    plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5326 				  + (htab->plt_slot_size
5327 				     * ((s->size
5328 					 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5329 					/ htab->plt_entry_size)));
5330 
5331 		    /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5332 		       file, and we are not generating a shared
5333 		       library, then set the symbol to this location
5334 		       in the .plt.  This is to avoid text
5335 		       relocations, and is required to make
5336 		       function pointers compare as equal between
5337 		       the normal executable and the shared library.  */
5338 		    if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5339 			&& h->def_dynamic
5340 			&& !h->def_regular)
5341 		      {
5342 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
5343 			h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5344 		      }
5345 
5346 		    /* Make room for this entry.  */
5347 		    s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5348 		    /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5349 		       is allocated.  */
5350 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5351 			&& (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5352 			/ htab->plt_entry_size
5353 			> PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5354 		      s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5355 		  }
5356 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5357 	      }
5358 
5359 	    /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
5360 	    if (!doneone)
5361 	      {
5362 		if (!dyn)
5363 		  {
5364 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5365 		      {
5366 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5367 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5368 		      }
5369 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5370 		      {
5371 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
5372 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5373 		      }
5374 		  }
5375 		else
5376 		  {
5377 		    htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5378 
5379 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5380 		      {
5381 			/* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations.  */
5382 			if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5383 			    && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5384 			  {
5385 			    if (ent->plt.offset
5386 				== (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5387 			      {
5388 				htab->srelplt2->size
5389 				  += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5390 				      * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5391 			      }
5392 
5393 			    htab->srelplt2->size
5394 			      += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5395 				  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5396 			  }
5397 
5398 			/* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5399 			   .got.plt.  */
5400 			htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5401 		      }
5402 		  }
5403 		doneone = TRUE;
5404 	      }
5405 	  }
5406 	else
5407 	  ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5408 
5409       if (!doneone)
5410 	{
5411 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
5412 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
5413 	}
5414     }
5415   else
5416     {
5417       h->plt.plist = NULL;
5418       h->needs_plt = 0;
5419     }
5420 
5421   return TRUE;
5422 }
5423 
5424 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
5425    read-only sections.  */
5426 
5427 static bfd_boolean
maybe_set_textrel(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * info_p)5428 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *info_p)
5429 {
5430   asection *sec;
5431 
5432   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5433     return TRUE;
5434 
5435   sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
5436   if (sec != NULL)
5437     {
5438       struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) info_p;
5439 
5440       info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5441       /* xgettext:c-format */
5442       info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT' "
5443 				"in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5444 			      sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
5445       if ((info->warn_shared_textrel && bfd_link_pic (info))
5446 	  || info->error_textrel)
5447 	/* xgettext:c-format */
5448 	info->callbacks->einfo (_("%P: %pB: warning: relocation against `%s' "
5449 				  "in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5450 				sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
5451 
5452       /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal.  */
5453       return FALSE;
5454     }
5455   return TRUE;
5456 }
5457 
5458 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5459 {
5460   0, 0, 0, 16,				/* length.  */
5461   0, 0, 0, 0,				/* id.  */
5462   1,					/* CIE version.  */
5463   'z', 'R', 0,				/* Augmentation string.  */
5464   4,					/* Code alignment.  */
5465   0x7c,					/* Data alignment.  */
5466   65,					/* RA reg.  */
5467   1,					/* Augmentation size.  */
5468   DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4,	/* FDE encoding.  */
5469   DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0			/* def_cfa: r1 offset 0.  */
5470 };
5471 
5472 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
5473 
5474 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)5475 ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5476 			       struct bfd_link_info *info)
5477 {
5478   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5479   asection *s;
5480   bfd_boolean relocs;
5481   bfd *ibfd;
5482 
5483 #ifdef DEBUG
5484   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5485 #endif
5486 
5487   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5488   BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5489 
5490   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5491     {
5492       /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
5493       if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5494 	{
5495 	  s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5496 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5497 	  s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5498 	  s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5499 	}
5500     }
5501 
5502   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5503     htab->got_header_size = 16;
5504   else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5505     htab->got_header_size = 12;
5506 
5507   /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5508      relocs.  */
5509   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5510     {
5511       bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5512       bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5513       struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5514       struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5515       char *lgot_masks;
5516       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5517       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5518 
5519       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5520 	continue;
5521 
5522       for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5523 	{
5524 	  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5525 
5526 	  for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5527 		    elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5528 	       p != NULL;
5529 	       p = p->next)
5530 	    {
5531 	      if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5532 		  && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5533 		{
5534 		  /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5535 		     it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5536 		     linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5537 		     the relocs too.  */
5538 		}
5539 	      else if (htab->is_vxworks
5540 		       && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5541 				  ".tls_vars") == 0)
5542 		{
5543 		  /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5544 		     handled specially by the loader.  */
5545 		}
5546 	      else if (p->count != 0)
5547 		{
5548 		  asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5549 		  if (p->ifunc)
5550 		    sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5551 		  sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5552 		  if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5553 		       & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5554 		      == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5555 		    {
5556 		      info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5557 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5558 					      p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5559 		    }
5560 		}
5561 	    }
5562 	}
5563 
5564       local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5565       if (!local_got)
5566 	continue;
5567 
5568       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5569       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5570       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5571       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5572       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5573       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5574 
5575       for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5576 	if (*local_got > 0)
5577 	  {
5578 	    unsigned int need;
5579 	    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5580 	      htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5581 	    need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5582 	    if (need == 0)
5583 	      *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5584 	    else
5585 	      {
5586 		*local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5587 		if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5588 		    && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
5589 			 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
5590 		  {
5591 		    asection *srel;
5592 
5593 		    need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5594 		    srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5595 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5596 		      srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5597 		    srel->size += need;
5598 		  }
5599 	      }
5600 	  }
5601 	else
5602 	  *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5603 
5604       if (htab->is_vxworks)
5605 	continue;
5606 
5607       /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt.  */
5608       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5609       for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5610 	{
5611 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
5612 	  bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5613 	  bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5614 
5615 	  for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5616 	    if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5617 	      {
5618 		if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5619 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
5620 		else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5621 			 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5622 		  {
5623 		    ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5624 		    continue;
5625 		  }
5626 		else
5627 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
5628 
5629 		if (!doneone)
5630 		  {
5631 		    plt_offset = s->size;
5632 		    s->size += 4;
5633 		  }
5634 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5635 
5636 		if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5637 		  {
5638 		    s = htab->glink;
5639 		    glink_offset = s->size;
5640 		    s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5641 		  }
5642 		ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5643 
5644 		if (!doneone)
5645 		  {
5646 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5647 		      {
5648 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5649 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5650 		      }
5651 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5652 		      {
5653 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
5654 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5655 		      }
5656 		    doneone = TRUE;
5657 		  }
5658 	      }
5659 	    else
5660 	      ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5661 	}
5662     }
5663 
5664   /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs.  */
5665   elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5666 
5667   if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5668     {
5669       htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5670       if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5671 	htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5672     }
5673   else
5674     htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5675 
5676   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5677     {
5678       unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5679 
5680       /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now.  When we get here,
5681 	 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5682 	 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated).  For new plt/got, the
5683 	 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536.  */
5684       if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5685 	{
5686 	  g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5687 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5688 	    g_o_t += 4;
5689 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5690 	}
5691 
5692       htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5693     }
5694   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5695     {
5696       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5697 
5698       sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5699       sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5700     }
5701   if (info->emitrelocations)
5702     {
5703       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5704 
5705       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5706 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5707       sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5708       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5709 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5710     }
5711 
5712   if (htab->glink != NULL
5713       && htab->glink->size != 0
5714       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5715     {
5716       htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5717       /* Space for the branch table.  */
5718       htab->glink->size
5719 	+= htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5720       /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve.  */
5721       htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5722 						 ? 63 : 15);
5723       htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5724 
5725       if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5726 	{
5727 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5728 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5729 				     TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5730 	  if (sh == NULL)
5731 	    return FALSE;
5732 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5733 	    {
5734 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5735 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5736 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5737 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
5738 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
5739 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5740 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
5741 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
5742 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5743 	    }
5744 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5745 				     TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5746 	  if (sh == NULL)
5747 	    return FALSE;
5748 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5749 	    {
5750 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5751 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5752 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5753 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
5754 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
5755 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5756 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
5757 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
5758 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5759 	    }
5760 	}
5761     }
5762 
5763   if (htab->glink != NULL
5764       && htab->glink->size != 0
5765       && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5766       && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5767       && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5768     {
5769       s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5770       s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5771       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5772 	{
5773 	  s->size += 4;
5774 	  if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5775 	    s->size += 4;
5776 	}
5777     }
5778 
5779   /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5780      Allocate memory for them.  */
5781   relocs = FALSE;
5782   for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5783     {
5784       bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5785 
5786       if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5787 	continue;
5788 
5789       if (s == htab->elf.splt
5790 	  || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5791 	{
5792 	  /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5793 	     we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5794 	     It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols.  */
5795 	  if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5796 	    strip_section = FALSE;
5797 	  /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5798 	     comment below.  */
5799 	}
5800       else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5801 	       || s == htab->pltlocal
5802 	       || s == htab->glink
5803 	       || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5804 	       || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5805 	       || s == htab->sbss
5806 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5807 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5808 	       || s == htab->dynsbss)
5809 	{
5810 	  /* Strip these too.  */
5811 	}
5812       else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5813 	       || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5814 	{
5815 	  strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5816 	}
5817       else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
5818 	{
5819 	  if (s->size != 0)
5820 	    {
5821 	      /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections.  */
5822 	      relocs = TRUE;
5823 
5824 	      /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5825 		 to copy relocs into the output file.  */
5826 	      s->reloc_count = 0;
5827 	    }
5828 	}
5829       else
5830 	{
5831 	  /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
5832 	  continue;
5833 	}
5834 
5835       if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5836 	{
5837 	  /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5838 	     output file.  This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5839 	     .rela.plt.  We must create both sections in
5840 	     create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5841 	     before the linker maps input sections to output
5842 	     sections.  The linker does that before
5843 	     adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5844 	     function which decides whether anything needs to go
5845 	     into these sections.  */
5846 	  s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5847 	  continue;
5848 	}
5849 
5850       if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5851 	continue;
5852 
5853       /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  */
5854       s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5855       if (s->contents == NULL)
5856 	return FALSE;
5857     }
5858 
5859   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5860     {
5861       /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
5862 	 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5863 	 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5864 	 the .dynamic section.  The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5865 	 dynamic linker and used by the debugger.  */
5866 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5867   _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5868 
5869       if (bfd_link_executable (info))
5870 	{
5871 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
5872 	    return FALSE;
5873 	}
5874 
5875       if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
5876 	{
5877 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
5878 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
5879 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
5880 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
5881 	    return FALSE;
5882 	}
5883 
5884       if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5885 	  && htab->glink != NULL
5886 	  && htab->glink->size != 0)
5887 	{
5888 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5889 	    return FALSE;
5890 	  if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5891 	      && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5892 	      && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5893 	      && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5894 	    return FALSE;
5895 	}
5896 
5897       if (relocs)
5898 	{
5899 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
5900 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
5901 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
5902 	    return FALSE;
5903 	}
5904 
5905       /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section, then we
5906 	 need a DT_TEXTREL entry.  */
5907       if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
5908 	elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), maybe_set_textrel,
5909 				info);
5910 
5911       if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
5912 	{
5913 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
5914 	    return FALSE;
5915 	}
5916       if (htab->is_vxworks
5917 	  && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
5918 	return FALSE;
5919    }
5920 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5921 
5922   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5923       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5924     {
5925       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5926       bfd_vma val;
5927 
5928       memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5929       /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian).  */
5930       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5931       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5932       /* FDE length.  */
5933       val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5934       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5935       p += 4;
5936       /* CIE pointer.  */
5937       val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5938       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5939       p += 4;
5940       /* Offset to .glink.  Set later.  */
5941       p += 4;
5942       /* .glink size.  */
5943       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5944       p += 4;
5945       /* Augmentation.  */
5946       p += 1;
5947 
5948       if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5949 	  && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5950 	{
5951 	  bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5952 	  if (adv < 64)
5953 	    *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5954 	  else if (adv < 256)
5955 	    {
5956 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5957 	      *p++ = adv;
5958 	    }
5959 	  else if (adv < 65536)
5960 	    {
5961 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5962 	      bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5963 	      p += 2;
5964 	    }
5965 	  else
5966 	    {
5967 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5968 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5969 	      p += 4;
5970 	    }
5971 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5972 	  *p++ = 65;
5973 	  p++;
5974 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5975 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5976 	  *p++ = 65;
5977 	}
5978       BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5979 		  == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5980     }
5981 
5982   return TRUE;
5983 }
5984 
5985 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5986    if it looks like nothing is using them.  */
5987 
5988 static void
maybe_strip_sdasym(bfd * output_bfd,elf_linker_section_t * lsect)5989 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
5990 {
5991   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
5992 
5993   if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
5994     {
5995       asection *s;
5996 
5997       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
5998       if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5999 	{
6000 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
6001 	  if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6002 	    {
6003 	      sda->def_regular = 0;
6004 	      /* This is somewhat magic.  See elf_link_output_extsym.  */
6005 	      sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
6006 	      sda->forced_local = 0;
6007 	    }
6008 	}
6009     }
6010 }
6011 
6012 void
ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms(struct bfd_link_info * info)6013 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6014 {
6015   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6016 
6017   if (htab != NULL)
6018     {
6019       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6020       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6021     }
6022 }
6023 
6024 
6025 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section.  */
6026 
6027 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_hash_symbol(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)6028 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6029 {
6030   if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6031       && !h->def_regular
6032       && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6033 	  || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6034     return FALSE;
6035 
6036   return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6037 }
6038 
6039 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6040 
6041 /* Relaxation trampolines.  r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6042    used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI).  */
6043 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6044   {
6045     0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6046     0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6047     0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6048     0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6049     0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6050     0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6051     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6052     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6053   };
6054 
6055 static const int stub_entry[] =
6056   {
6057     0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6058     0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6059     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6060     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6061   };
6062 
6063 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6064 {
6065   unsigned int workaround_size;
6066   unsigned int picfixup_size;
6067 };
6068 
6069 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6070    icache bug workaround.  Any section needing trampolines or patch
6071    space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6072    add trampolines at the end of the section.  */
6073 
6074 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_relax_section(bfd * abfd,asection * isec,struct bfd_link_info * link_info,bfd_boolean * again)6075 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6076 		       asection *isec,
6077 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6078 		       bfd_boolean *again)
6079 {
6080   struct one_branch_fixup
6081   {
6082     struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6083     asection *tsec;
6084     /* Final link, can use the symbol offset.  For a
6085        relocatable link we use the symbol's index.  */
6086     bfd_vma toff;
6087     bfd_vma trampoff;
6088   };
6089 
6090   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6091   bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6092   Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6093   Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6094   Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6095   struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6096   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6097   unsigned changes = 0;
6098   bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6099   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6100   bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6101   asection *got2;
6102   bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6103 
6104   *again = FALSE;
6105 
6106   /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections.  */
6107   if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6108       || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6109       || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6110       || isec->size < 4)
6111     return TRUE;
6112 
6113   /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6114      do anything.  The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6115      anyway.  */
6116   if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6117     return TRUE;
6118 
6119   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6120   if (htab == NULL)
6121     return TRUE;
6122 
6123   isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6124   if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6125     isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6126   trampbase = isec->size;
6127 
6128   BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6129 	      || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6130   isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6131 
6132   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6133       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6134     {
6135       if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6136 	{
6137 	  elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6138 	    = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6139 	  if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6140 	    return FALSE;
6141 	}
6142       relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6143       trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6144     }
6145 
6146   maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6147 		  || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6148   /* Space for a branch around any trampolines.  */
6149   trampoff = trampbase;
6150   if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6151     trampoff += 4;
6152 
6153   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6154   picfixup_size = 0;
6155   if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6156       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6157     {
6158       /* Get a copy of the native relocations.  */
6159       if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6160 	{
6161 	  internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6162 						       link_info->keep_memory);
6163 	  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6164 	    goto error_return;
6165 	}
6166 
6167       got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6168 
6169       irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6170       for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6171 	{
6172 	  unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6173 	  bfd_vma toff, roff;
6174 	  asection *tsec;
6175 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6176 	  size_t insn_offset = 0;
6177 	  bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6178 	  bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6179 	  unsigned long t0;
6180 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6181 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6182 	  struct plt_entry **plist;
6183 	  unsigned char sym_type;
6184 
6185 	  switch (r_type)
6186 	    {
6187 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
6188 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6189 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6190 	    case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6191 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6192 	      break;
6193 
6194 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
6195 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6196 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6197 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6198 	      break;
6199 
6200 	    case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6201 	      if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6202 		break;
6203 	      continue;
6204 
6205 	    default:
6206 	      continue;
6207 	    }
6208 
6209 	  /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc.  */
6210 	  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6211 			  ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6212 	    goto error_return;
6213 
6214 	  if (isym != NULL)
6215 	    {
6216 	      if (tsec != NULL)
6217 		;
6218 	      else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6219 		tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6220 	      else
6221 		continue;
6222 
6223 	      toff = isym->st_value;
6224 	      sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6225 	    }
6226 	  else
6227 	    {
6228 	      if (tsec != NULL)
6229 		toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6230 	      else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6231 		       || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6232 		{
6233 		  unsigned long indx;
6234 
6235 		  indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6236 		  tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6237 		  toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6238 		}
6239 	      else
6240 		continue;
6241 
6242 	      /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6243 		 optimise away the call.  We won't be needing a long-
6244 		 branch stub in that case.  */
6245 	      if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6246 		  && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6247 		  && irel != internal_relocs)
6248 		{
6249 		  unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6250 		  unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6251 		  unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6252 
6253 		  /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6254 		     R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6255 		     on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn.  Get tls
6256 		     mask bits from the symbol on that reloc.  */
6257 		  if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6258 		    {
6259 		      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6260 
6261 		      if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6262 			{
6263 			  struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6264 			    (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6265 			  char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6266 			    (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6267 			  tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6268 			}
6269 		    }
6270 		  else
6271 		    {
6272 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6273 			= elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6274 
6275 		      while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6276 			     || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6277 			th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6278 
6279 		      tls_mask
6280 			= ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6281 		    }
6282 
6283 		  /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6284 		     optimised away.  */
6285 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6286 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6287 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6288 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6289 		    continue;
6290 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6291 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6292 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6293 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6294 		    continue;
6295 		}
6296 
6297 	      sym_type = h->type;
6298 	    }
6299 
6300 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6301 	    {
6302 	      if (h != NULL
6303 		  && !h->def_regular
6304 		  && h->protected_def
6305 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6306 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6307 		picfixup_size += 12;
6308 	      continue;
6309 	    }
6310 
6311 	  /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6312 	     match that in relocate_section.  If we call find_plt_ent here
6313 	     but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6314 	     destination used here may be incorrect.  */
6315 	  plist = NULL;
6316 	  if (h != NULL)
6317 	    {
6318 	      /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true.  */
6319 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6320 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6321 		plist = &h->plt.plist;
6322 	    }
6323 	  else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6324 		   && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6325 	    {
6326 	      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6327 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6328 		(local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6329 	      plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6330 	    }
6331 	  if (plist != NULL)
6332 	    {
6333 	      bfd_vma addend = 0;
6334 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
6335 
6336 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6337 		addend = irel->r_addend;
6338 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6339 	      if (ent != NULL)
6340 		{
6341 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6342 		      || h == NULL
6343 		      || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6344 		      || h->dynindx == -1)
6345 		    {
6346 		      tsec = htab->glink;
6347 		      toff = ent->glink_offset;
6348 		    }
6349 		  else
6350 		    {
6351 		      tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6352 		      toff = ent->plt.offset;
6353 		    }
6354 		}
6355 	    }
6356 
6357 	  /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6358 	     no hope of adding stubs.  We'll error out later should the
6359 	     branch overflow.  */
6360 	  if (tsec == isec)
6361 	    continue;
6362 
6363 	  /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6364 	     undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6365 	     support addends.  It would be possible to do so by
6366 	     putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6367 	     branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting.  */
6368 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6369 	      && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6370 	      && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6371 	      && irel->r_addend != 0)
6372 	    continue;
6373 
6374 	  /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6375 	     SEC_MERGE sections;  SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6376 	     attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6377 	     branches.  However, implement it correctly here as a
6378 	     reference for other target relax_section functions.  */
6379 	  if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6380 	    {
6381 	      /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6382 		 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6383 		 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset.  (Later, in
6384 		 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6385 		 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6386 
6387 		 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6388 		 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6389 		 the original addend was zero.  When the reloc is against
6390 		 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6391 		 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6392 		 location of interest is the original symbol.  On the
6393 		 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6394 		 a section symbol should not include the addend;  Such an
6395 		 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym";  The
6396 		 location of interest is just "sym".  */
6397 	      if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6398 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6399 		toff += irel->r_addend;
6400 
6401 	      toff
6402 		= _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6403 					      elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6404 					      toff);
6405 
6406 	      if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6407 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6408 		toff += irel->r_addend;
6409 	    }
6410 	  /* PLTREL24 addends are special.  */
6411 	  else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6412 	    toff += irel->r_addend;
6413 
6414 	  /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses.  */
6415 	  if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6416 	       && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6417 	      || tsec->output_section == NULL
6418 	      || (tsec->owner != NULL
6419 		  && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6420 	    continue;
6421 
6422 	  roff = irel->r_offset;
6423 
6424 	  /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6425 	     relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6426 	     fixup can be created at final link.
6427 	     The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6428 	     of other fixups being needed at final link.  */
6429 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6430 	      && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6431 		  < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6432 	    continue;
6433 
6434 	  /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything.  */
6435 	  if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6436 	      && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6437 		  /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6438 		     final link, so do not presume they remain in range.  */
6439 		  || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6440 	    {
6441 	      bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6442 
6443 	      symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6444 	      reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6445 	      if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6446 		  < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6447 		continue;
6448 	    }
6449 
6450 	  /* Look for an existing fixup to this address.  */
6451 	  for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6452 	    if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6453 	      break;
6454 
6455 	  if (f == NULL)
6456 	    {
6457 	      size_t size;
6458 	      unsigned long stub_rtype;
6459 
6460 	      val = trampoff - roff;
6461 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6462 		/* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline.  Don't try to add
6463 		   one.  We'll report an error later.  */
6464 		continue;
6465 
6466 	      if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6467 		{
6468 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6469 		  insn_offset = 12;
6470 		}
6471 	      else
6472 		{
6473 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6474 		  insn_offset = 0;
6475 		}
6476 	      stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6477 	      if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6478 		  || tsec == htab->glink)
6479 		{
6480 		  stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6481 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6482 		    stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6483 		}
6484 
6485 	      /* Hijack the old relocation.  Since we need two
6486 		 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc.  */
6487 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6488 					   stub_rtype);
6489 	      irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6490 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6491 		  && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6492 		irel->r_addend = 0;
6493 
6494 	      /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section.  */
6495 	      f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6496 	      f->next = branch_fixups;
6497 	      f->tsec = tsec;
6498 	      f->toff = toff;
6499 	      f->trampoff = trampoff;
6500 	      branch_fixups = f;
6501 
6502 	      trampoff += size;
6503 	      changes++;
6504 	    }
6505 	  else
6506 	    {
6507 	      val = f->trampoff - roff;
6508 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6509 		continue;
6510 
6511 	      /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here.  */
6512 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6513 	    }
6514 
6515 	  /* Get the section contents.  */
6516 	  if (contents == NULL)
6517 	    {
6518 	      /* Get cached copy if it exists.  */
6519 	      if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6520 		contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6521 	      /* Go get them off disk.  */
6522 	      else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6523 		goto error_return;
6524 	    }
6525 
6526 	  /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline.  */
6527 	  hit_addr = contents + roff;
6528 	  switch (r_type)
6529 	    {
6530 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
6531 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6532 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6533 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6534 	      t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6535 	      t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6536 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6537 	      break;
6538 
6539 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
6540 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6541 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6542 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6543 	      t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6544 	      t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6545 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6546 	      break;
6547 	    }
6548 	}
6549 
6550       while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6551 	{
6552 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6553 	  branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6554 	  free (f);
6555 	}
6556     }
6557 
6558   workaround_change = FALSE;
6559   newsize = trampoff;
6560   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6561       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6562 	  || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6563     {
6564       bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6565       unsigned int crossings;
6566       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6567 
6568       addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6569       end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6570       addr &= -pagesize;
6571       crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6572       if (crossings != 0)
6573 	{
6574 	  /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6575 	     not cross a page.  Don't decrease size calculated on a
6576 	     previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout.  */
6577 	  newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6578 	  newsize += crossings * 16;
6579 	  if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6580 	    {
6581 	      relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6582 	      workaround_change = TRUE;
6583 	    }
6584 	  /* Ensure relocate_section is called.  */
6585 	  isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6586 	}
6587       newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6588     }
6589 
6590   if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6591     {
6592       picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6593       if (picfixup_size != 0)
6594 	relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6595       newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6596     }
6597 
6598   if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6599     isec->size = newsize;
6600 
6601   if (isymbuf != NULL
6602       && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6603     {
6604       if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6605 	free (isymbuf);
6606       else
6607 	{
6608 	  /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
6609 	  symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6610 	}
6611     }
6612 
6613   if (contents != NULL
6614       && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6615     {
6616       if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6617 	free (contents);
6618       else
6619 	{
6620 	  /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
6621 	  elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6622 	}
6623     }
6624 
6625   changes += picfixup_size;
6626   if (changes != 0)
6627     {
6628       /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6629 	 information for the trampolines.  */
6630       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6631       Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6632 						  * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6633       unsigned ix;
6634 
6635       if (!new_relocs)
6636 	goto error_return;
6637       memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6638 	      isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6639       for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6640 	{
6641 	  irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6642 
6643 	  irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6644 	}
6645       if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6646 	free (internal_relocs);
6647       elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6648       isec->reloc_count += changes;
6649       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6650       rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6651     }
6652   else if (internal_relocs != NULL
6653 	   && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6654     free (internal_relocs);
6655 
6656   *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6657   return TRUE;
6658 
6659  error_return:
6660   while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6661     {
6662       struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6663       branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6664       free (f);
6665     }
6666   if (isymbuf != NULL && (unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6667     free (isymbuf);
6668   if (contents != NULL
6669       && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6670     free (contents);
6671   if (internal_relocs != NULL
6672       && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6673     free (internal_relocs);
6674   return FALSE;
6675 }
6676 
6677 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6678    discarded sections.  */
6679 
6680 static unsigned int
ppc_elf_action_discarded(asection * sec)6681 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6682 {
6683   if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6684     return 0;
6685 
6686   if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6687     return 0;
6688 
6689   return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6690 }
6691 
6692 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section.  */
6693 
6694 static bfd_vma
elf_finish_pointer_linker_section(bfd * input_bfd,elf_linker_section_t * lsect,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd_vma relocation,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rel)6695 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6696 				   elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6697 				   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6698 				   bfd_vma relocation,
6699 				   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6700 {
6701   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6702 
6703   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6704 
6705   if (h != NULL)
6706     {
6707       /* Handle global symbol.  */
6708       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6709 
6710       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6711       BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6712       linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6713     }
6714   else
6715     {
6716       /* Handle local symbol.  */
6717       unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6718 
6719       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6720       BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6721       linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6722     }
6723 
6724   linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6725 							rel->r_addend,
6726 							lsect);
6727   BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6728 
6729   /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6730      as a "written" flag.  */
6731   if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6732     {
6733       bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6734 		  relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6735 		  lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6736       linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6737     }
6738 
6739   relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6740 		+ lsect->section->output_offset
6741 		+ linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6742 		- SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6743 
6744 #ifdef DEBUG
6745   fprintf (stderr,
6746 	   "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6747 	   lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6748 #endif
6749 
6750   return relocation;
6751 }
6752 
6753 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6754 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6755 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6756 
6757 static void
write_glink_stub(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,struct plt_entry * ent,asection * plt_sec,unsigned char * p,struct bfd_link_info * info)6758 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6759 		  asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6760 		  struct bfd_link_info *info)
6761 {
6762   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6763   bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6764   bfd_vma plt;
6765   unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6766 
6767   if (h != NULL
6768       && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6769       && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6770     {
6771       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6772       p += 4;
6773       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6774       p += 4;
6775       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6776       p += 4;
6777       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6778       p += 4;
6779       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6780       p += 4;
6781       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6782       p += 4;
6783       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6784       p += 4;
6785       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6786       p += 4;
6787     }
6788 
6789   plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6790 	 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6791 	 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6792 
6793   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6794     {
6795       bfd_vma got = 0;
6796 
6797       if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6798 	got = (ent->addend
6799 	       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6800 	       + ent->sec->output_offset);
6801       else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6802 	got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6803 
6804       plt -= got;
6805 
6806       if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6807 	bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6808       else
6809 	{
6810 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6811 	  p += 4;
6812 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6813 	}
6814     }
6815   else
6816     {
6817       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6818       p += 4;
6819       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6820     }
6821   p += 4;
6822   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6823   p += 4;
6824   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6825   p += 4;
6826   while (p < end)
6827     {
6828       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6829       p += 4;
6830     }
6831 }
6832 
6833 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically.  */
6834 
6835 static bfd_boolean
is_static_defined(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)6836 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6837 {
6838   return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6839 	   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6840 	  && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6841 	  && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6842 }
6843 
6844 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6845    the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0.  If
6846    REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG.  */
6847 
6848 unsigned int
_bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform(unsigned int insn,unsigned int reg)6849 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6850 {
6851   unsigned int rtra;
6852 
6853   if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6854     return 0;
6855 
6856   if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6857     rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6858   else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6859     rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6860   else
6861     return 0;
6862 
6863   if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6864     /* add -> addi.  */
6865     insn = 14 << 26;
6866   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6867 	   && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6868 	       || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6869 		   && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6870     /* load and store indexed -> dform.  */
6871     insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6872   else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6873     /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu.  */
6874     insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6875   else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6876     /* lwax -> lwa.  */
6877     insn = (58u << 26) | 2;
6878   else
6879     return 0;
6880   insn |= rtra;
6881   return insn;
6882 }
6883 
6884 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6885    the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6886    thread pointer REG operand removed.  Otherwise return 0.  */
6887 
6888 unsigned int
_bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform(unsigned int insn,unsigned int reg)6889 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6890 {
6891   if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6892       && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6893 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6894 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6895 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6896 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6897 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6898 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6899 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6900 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6901 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6902 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6903 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6904 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6905 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6906 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6907 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6908 	      && (insn & 3) != 1)
6909 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6910 	      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6911     {
6912       insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6913     }
6914   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6915 	   && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6916 	       || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6917 	       || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6918     {
6919       insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6920       insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6921       if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6922 	insn -= 2 >> 26;  /* convert to ori,oris */
6923     }
6924   else
6925     insn = 0;
6926   return insn;
6927 }
6928 
6929 static bfd_boolean
is_insn_ds_form(unsigned int insn)6930 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6931 {
6932   return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6933 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6934 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6935 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6936 }
6937 
6938 static bfd_boolean
is_insn_dq_form(unsigned int insn)6939 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6940 {
6941   return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6942 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6943 	      && (insn & 3) == 1));
6944 }
6945 
6946 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6947    to handle the relocations for a section.
6948 
6949    The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6950    actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6951    zero.
6952 
6953    This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6954    necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6955    relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6956    necessary.
6957 
6958    This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6959    address or the reloc symbol index.
6960 
6961    LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6962 
6963    LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6964    corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6965 
6966    The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6967    via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6968 
6969    When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6970    STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially.  The output symbol is
6971    going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6972    section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6973    accordingly.  */
6974 
6975 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_relocate_section(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,bfd_byte * contents,Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections)6976 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6977 			  struct bfd_link_info *info,
6978 			  bfd *input_bfd,
6979 			  asection *input_section,
6980 			  bfd_byte *contents,
6981 			  Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6982 			  Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6983 			  asection **local_sections)
6984 {
6985   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6986   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6987   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6988   Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6989   Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
6990   Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6991   Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
6992   asection *got2;
6993   bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
6994   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
6995   bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
6996   bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
6997   unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
6998   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6999 
7000 #ifdef DEBUG
7001   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
7002 		      "%ld relocations%s",
7003 		      input_bfd, input_section,
7004 		      (long) input_section->reloc_count,
7005 		      (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
7006 #endif
7007 
7008   if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
7009     {
7010       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7011       return FALSE;
7012     }
7013 
7014   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7015 
7016   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
7017   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7018     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7019 
7020   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7021   local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7022   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7023   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7024   /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7025      specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'.  */
7026   is_vxworks_tls = (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7027 		    && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7028 				".tls_vars"));
7029   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7030     relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7031   rel = wrel = relocs;
7032   relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7033   for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7034     {
7035       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7036       bfd_vma addend;
7037       bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7038       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7039       asection *sec;
7040       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7041       const char *sym_name;
7042       reloc_howto_type *howto;
7043       unsigned long r_symndx;
7044       bfd_vma relocation;
7045       bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7046       bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7047       bfd_boolean warned;
7048       unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7049       struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7050       struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7051 
7052     again:
7053       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7054       sym = NULL;
7055       sec = NULL;
7056       h = NULL;
7057       unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7058       warned = FALSE;
7059       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7060 
7061       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7062 	{
7063 	  sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7064 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7065 	  sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7066 
7067 	  relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7068 	}
7069       else
7070 	{
7071 	  bfd_boolean ignored;
7072 
7073 	  RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7074 				   r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7075 				   h, sec, relocation,
7076 				   unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7077 
7078 	  sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7079 	}
7080 
7081       if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7082 	{
7083 	  /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7084 	     or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7085 	     section contents zeroed.  Avoid any special processing.  */
7086 	  howto = NULL;
7087 	  if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7088 	    howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7089 
7090 	  _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7091 			       contents, rel->r_offset);
7092 	  wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7093 	  wrel->r_info = 0;
7094 	  wrel->r_addend = 0;
7095 
7096 	  /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7097 	     symbols defined in discarded sections.  Not done for
7098 	     non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7099 	     eh_frame editing code expects to be present.  */
7100 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7101 	      && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7102 	    wrel--;
7103 
7104 	  continue;
7105 	}
7106 
7107       if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7108 	{
7109 	  if (got2 != NULL
7110 	      && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7111 	      && rel->r_addend != 0)
7112 	    {
7113 	      /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
7114 		 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.  */
7115 	      rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7116 	    }
7117 	  if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7118 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7119 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7120 	    goto copy_reloc;
7121 	}
7122 
7123       /* TLS optimizations.  Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7124 	 based on information we collected in tls_optimize.  We edit
7125 	 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7126 	 for the final instruction stream.  */
7127       tls_mask = 0;
7128       tls_gd = 0;
7129       if (h != NULL)
7130 	tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7131       else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7132 	{
7133 	  struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7134 	  char *lgot_masks;
7135 	  local_plt
7136 	    = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7137 	  lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7138 	  tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7139 	}
7140 
7141       /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane.  */
7142       if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7143 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7144 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7145 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7146 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7147 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7148 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7149 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7150 	abort ();
7151       switch (r_type)
7152 	{
7153 	default:
7154 	  break;
7155 
7156 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7157 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7158 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7159 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7160 	    {
7161 	      bfd_vma insn;
7162 
7163 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7164 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7165 	      insn &= 31 << 21;
7166 	      insn |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis 0,2,0 */
7167 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7168 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7169 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7170 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7171 	    }
7172 	  break;
7173 
7174 	case R_PPC_TLS:
7175 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7176 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7177 	    {
7178 	      bfd_vma insn;
7179 
7180 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7181 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7182 	      if (insn == 0)
7183 		abort ();
7184 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7185 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7186 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7187 
7188 	      /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7189 		 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word.  */
7190 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7191 	    }
7192 	  break;
7193 
7194 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7195 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7196 	  tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7197 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7198 	    goto tls_gdld_hi;
7199 	  break;
7200 
7201 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7202 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7203 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7204 	    {
7205 	    tls_gdld_hi:
7206 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7207 		r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7208 			  + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7209 	      else
7210 		{
7211 		  rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7212 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7213 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7214 		}
7215 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7216 	    }
7217 	  break;
7218 
7219 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7220 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7221 	  tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7222 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7223 	    goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7224 	  break;
7225 
7226 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7227 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7228 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7229 	    {
7230 	      unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7231 	      bfd_vma offset;
7232 
7233 	    tls_ldgd_opt:
7234 	      offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7235 	      /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7236 		 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7237 		 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7238 		 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7239 		 the current reloc.  Edit both insns.  */
7240 	      if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
7241 		  && rel + 1 < relend
7242 		  && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7243 					      htab->tls_get_addr))
7244 		offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7245 	      /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7246 		 the destination reg.  It may be something other than
7247 		 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7248 		 intervening code.  */
7249 	      insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7250 				  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7251 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7252 		{
7253 		  /* IE */
7254 		  insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7255 		  insn1 |= 32u << 26;	/* lwz */
7256 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7257 		    {
7258 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7259 		      insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
7260 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7261 		    }
7262 		  r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7263 			    + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7264 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7265 		}
7266 	      else
7267 		{
7268 		  /* LE */
7269 		  insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7270 		  insn1 |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis r,2,0 */
7271 		  if (tls_gd == 0)
7272 		    {
7273 		      /* Was an LD reloc.  */
7274 		      for (r_symndx = 0;
7275 			   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7276 			   r_symndx++)
7277 			if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7278 			  break;
7279 		      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7280 			r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7281 		      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7282 		      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7283 			rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7284 					  + sec->output_offset
7285 					  + sec->output_section->vma);
7286 		    }
7287 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7288 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7289 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7290 		    {
7291 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7292 		      rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7293 		      rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7294 		      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
7295 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7296 		    }
7297 		}
7298 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7299 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7300 	      if (tls_gd == 0)
7301 		{
7302 		  /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc.  Start over
7303 		     in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right.  */
7304 		  goto again;
7305 		}
7306 	    }
7307 	  break;
7308 
7309 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7310 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7311 	      && rel + 1 < relend)
7312 	    {
7313 	      unsigned int insn2;
7314 	      bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7315 
7316 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7317 		{
7318 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7319 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7320 		  break;
7321 		}
7322 
7323 	      if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7324 		{
7325 		  /* IE */
7326 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7327 		  insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
7328 		}
7329 	      else
7330 		{
7331 		  /* LE */
7332 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7333 		  rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7334 		  insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
7335 		}
7336 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7337 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7338 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
7339 	      BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7340 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7341 	    }
7342 	  break;
7343 
7344 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7345 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7346 	      && rel + 1 < relend)
7347 	    {
7348 	      unsigned int insn2;
7349 
7350 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7351 		{
7352 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7353 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7354 		  break;
7355 		}
7356 
7357 	      for (r_symndx = 0;
7358 		   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7359 		   r_symndx++)
7360 		if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7361 		  break;
7362 	      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7363 		r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7364 	      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7365 	      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7366 		rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7367 				  + sec->output_offset
7368 				  + sec->output_section->vma);
7369 
7370 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7371 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7372 	      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
7373 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7374 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7375 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
7376 	      BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7377 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7378 	      goto again;
7379 	    }
7380 	  break;
7381 	}
7382 
7383       /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn.  */
7384       branch_bit = 0;
7385       switch (r_type)
7386 	{
7387 	default:
7388 	  break;
7389 
7390 	  /* Branch taken prediction relocations.  */
7391 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7392 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7393 	  branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7394 	  /* Fall through.  */
7395 
7396 	  /* Branch not taken prediction relocations.  */
7397 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7398 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7399 	  {
7400 	    unsigned int insn;
7401 
7402 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7403 	    insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7404 	    insn |= branch_bit;
7405 
7406 	    from = (rel->r_offset
7407 		    + input_section->output_offset
7408 		    + input_section->output_section->vma);
7409 
7410 	    /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default.  */
7411 	    if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7412 	      insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7413 
7414 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7415 	  }
7416 	  break;
7417 
7418 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7419 	  {
7420 	    unsigned int insn;
7421 
7422 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7423 			       contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7424 	    if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26
7425 		&& (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7426 	      {
7427 		if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7428 		  {
7429 		    /* Convert addis to lis.  */
7430 		    insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7431 		    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7432 				contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7433 		  }
7434 	      }
7435 	    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7436 	      info->callbacks->einfo
7437 		(_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7438 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7439 		 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7440 	  }
7441 	  break;
7442 	}
7443 
7444       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7445 	  && h != NULL
7446 	  && !h->def_regular
7447 	  && h->protected_def
7448 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7449 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7450 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7451 	{
7452 	  /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7453 	     variable defined in a shared library to PIC.  */
7454 	  unsigned int insn;
7455 
7456 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7457 	    {
7458 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7459 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7460 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7461 		  && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7462 		{
7463 		  bfd_byte *p;
7464 		  bfd_vma off;
7465 		  bfd_vma got_addr;
7466 
7467 		  p = (contents + input_section->size
7468 		       - relax_info->workaround_size
7469 		       - relax_info->picfixup_size
7470 		       + picfixup_size);
7471 		  off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7472 		  if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7473 		    info->callbacks->einfo
7474 		      (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7475 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7476 
7477 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7478 			      contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7479 		  got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7480 			      + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7481 			      + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7482 		  wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7483 		  wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7484 		  wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7485 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
7486 		  insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7487 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7488 
7489 		  /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT.  */
7490 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
7491 		  insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7492 		  insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7493 		  insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7494 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7495 
7496 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7497 		  picfixup_size += 12;
7498 
7499 		  /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7500 		     output is reasonable.  */
7501 		  memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7502 		  wrel++, rel++;
7503 		  rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7504 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7505 		  rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7506 
7507 		  /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7508 		     dynamic reloc.  */
7509 		  r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7510 		}
7511 	      else
7512 		_bfd_error_handler
7513 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
7514 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7515 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7516 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7517 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7518 	    }
7519 	  else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7520 	    {
7521 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7522 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7523 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26    /* addi */
7524 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7525 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7526 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7527 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7528 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7529 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7530 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7531 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7532 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7533 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7534 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7535 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7536 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7537 		  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7538 		      && (insn & 3) != 1)
7539 		  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7540 		      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7541 		{
7542 		  /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any.  */
7543 		  relocation = 0;
7544 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7545 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7546 		}
7547 	      else
7548 		_bfd_error_handler
7549 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
7550 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7551 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7552 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7553 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7554 	    }
7555 	}
7556 
7557       ifunc = NULL;
7558       if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7559 	{
7560 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
7561 
7562 	  if (h != NULL)
7563 	    {
7564 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7565 		ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7566 	    }
7567 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7568 		   && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7569 	    {
7570 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7571 
7572 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7573 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7574 	      ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7575 	    }
7576 
7577 	  ent = NULL;
7578 	  if (ifunc != NULL
7579 	      && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7580 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7581 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7582 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7583 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7584 	    {
7585 	      addend = 0;
7586 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7587 		  && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7588 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7589 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7590 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7591 		addend = rel->r_addend;
7592 	      ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7593 	    }
7594 	  if (ent != NULL)
7595 	    {
7596 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7597 		  && ent->sec != got2
7598 		  && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7599 		  && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7600 		      || h == NULL
7601 		      || h->dynindx == -1))
7602 		{
7603 		  /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7604 		     for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7605 		     finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7606 		     apparently are using code compiled with
7607 		     -mbss-plt.  The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7608 		     gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7609 		     whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7610 		     is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7611 		     into .got2).  */
7612 		    info->callbacks->einfo
7613 		      /* xgettext:c-format */
7614 		      (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7615 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7616 		}
7617 
7618 	      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7619 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7620 		  || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7621 		  || h == NULL
7622 		  || h->dynindx == -1)
7623 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7624 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
7625 			      + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7626 	      else
7627 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7628 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7629 			      + ent->plt.offset);
7630 	    }
7631 	}
7632 
7633       addend = rel->r_addend;
7634       save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7635       howto = NULL;
7636       if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7637 	howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7638 
7639       switch (r_type)
7640 	{
7641 	default:
7642 	  break;
7643 
7644 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7645 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7646 	    {
7647 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7648 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7649 	      if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
7650 		  != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
7651 		/* xgettext:c-format */
7652 		info->callbacks->minfo
7653 		  (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
7654 		   input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
7655 	      else
7656 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
7657 	    }
7658 	  break;
7659 
7660 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7661 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7662 	    {
7663 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7664 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7665 	      insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7666 	      insn |= 2 << 16;
7667 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7668 	    }
7669 	  break;
7670 	}
7671 
7672       tls_type = 0;
7673       switch (r_type)
7674 	{
7675 	default:
7676 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
7677 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7678 			      input_bfd, howto->name);
7679 
7680 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7681 	  ret = FALSE;
7682 	  goto copy_reloc;
7683 
7684 	case R_PPC_NONE:
7685 	case R_PPC_TLS:
7686 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7687 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7688 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7689 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7690 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7691 	  goto copy_reloc;
7692 
7693 	  /* GOT16 relocations.  Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7694 	     address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7695 	     symbol's value itself.  Also, create a GOT entry for the
7696 	     symbol and put the symbol value there.  */
7697 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7698 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7699 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7700 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7701 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7702 	  goto dogot;
7703 
7704 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7705 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7706 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7707 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7708 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7709 	  goto dogot;
7710 
7711 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7712 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7713 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7714 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7715 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7716 	  goto dogot;
7717 
7718 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7719 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7720 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7721 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7722 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7723 	  goto dogot;
7724 
7725 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
7726 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7727 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7728 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7729 	  tls_mask = 0;
7730 	dogot:
7731 	  {
7732 	    /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7733 	       offset table.  */
7734 	    bfd_vma off;
7735 	    bfd_vma *offp;
7736 	    unsigned long indx;
7737 
7738 	    if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7739 	      abort ();
7740 
7741 	    indx = 0;
7742 	    if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7743 		&& SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7744 	      offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7745 	    else if (h != NULL)
7746 	      {
7747 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7748 		    || h->dynindx == -1
7749 		    || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7750 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7751 		  /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7752 		     -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7753 		     locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7754 		     because of a version file.  */
7755 		  ;
7756 		else
7757 		  {
7758 		    indx = h->dynindx;
7759 		    unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7760 		  }
7761 		offp = &h->got.offset;
7762 	      }
7763 	    else
7764 	      {
7765 		if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7766 		  abort ();
7767 		offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7768 	      }
7769 
7770 	    /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4.  We use the
7771 	       least significant bit to record whether we have already
7772 	       processed this entry.  */
7773 	    off = *offp;
7774 	    if ((off & 1) != 0)
7775 	      off &= ~1;
7776 	    else
7777 	      {
7778 		unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7779 				      ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7780 						    | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7781 				      : 0);
7782 
7783 		if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7784 		  tls_m = TLS_LD;
7785 		else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
7786 			 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7787 		  tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7788 
7789 		/* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7790 		   Initialize them all.  */
7791 		do
7792 		  {
7793 		    int tls_ty = 0;
7794 
7795 		    if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7796 		      {
7797 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7798 			tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7799 		      }
7800 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7801 		      {
7802 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7803 			tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7804 		      }
7805 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7806 		      {
7807 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7808 			tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7809 		      }
7810 		    else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7811 		      {
7812 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7813 			tls_m = 0;
7814 		      }
7815 
7816 		    /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker.  */
7817 		    if (indx != 0
7818 			|| (bfd_link_pic (info)
7819 			    && (h == NULL
7820 				|| !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7821 			    && !(tls_ty != 0
7822 				 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7823 				 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7824 		      {
7825 			asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7826 			bfd_byte * loc;
7827 
7828 			if (ifunc != NULL)
7829 			  {
7830 			    rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7831 			    if (indx == 0)
7832 			      htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7833 			    else if (is_static_defined (h))
7834 			      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7835 			  }
7836 			outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7837 					   + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7838 					   + off);
7839 			outrel.r_addend = 0;
7840 			if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7841 			  {
7842 			    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7843 			    if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7844 			      {
7845 				loc = rsec->contents;
7846 				loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7847 					* sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7848 				bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7849 							   &outrel, loc);
7850 				outrel.r_offset += 4;
7851 				outrel.r_info
7852 				  = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7853 			      }
7854 			  }
7855 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7856 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7857 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7858 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7859 			else if (indx != 0)
7860 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7861 			else if (ifunc != NULL)
7862 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7863 			else
7864 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7865 			if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7866 			  {
7867 			    outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7868 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7869 			      {
7870 				if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7871 				  outrel.r_addend = 0;
7872 				else
7873 				  outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7874 			      }
7875 			  }
7876 			loc = rsec->contents;
7877 			loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7878 				* sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7879 			bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7880 		      }
7881 
7882 		    /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7883 		       emitting a reloc.  */
7884 		    else
7885 		      {
7886 			bfd_vma value = relocation;
7887 
7888 			if (tls_ty != 0)
7889 			  {
7890 			    if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7891 			      value = 0;
7892 			    else
7893 			      {
7894 				if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7895 				  value = 0;
7896 				else
7897 				  value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7898 				if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7899 				  value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7900 			      }
7901 
7902 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7903 			      {
7904 				bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7905 					    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7906 				value = 1;
7907 			      }
7908 			  }
7909 			bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7910 				    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7911 		      }
7912 
7913 		    off += 4;
7914 		    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7915 		      off += 4;
7916 		  }
7917 		while (tls_m != 0);
7918 
7919 		off = *offp;
7920 		*offp = off | 1;
7921 	      }
7922 
7923 	    if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7924 	      abort ();
7925 
7926 	    if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7927 	      {
7928 		if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7929 		  {
7930 		    if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7931 			&& !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7932 		      off += 8;
7933 		    if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7934 		      {
7935 			if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7936 			  off += 8;
7937 			if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7938 			  {
7939 			    if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7940 			      off += 4;
7941 			  }
7942 		      }
7943 		  }
7944 	      }
7945 
7946 	    /* If here for a picfixup, we're done.  */
7947 	    if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7948 	      goto copy_reloc;
7949 
7950 	    relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7951 			  + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7952 			  + off
7953 			  - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7954 
7955 	    /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7956 	       x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7957 	       generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7958 	       got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m.  */
7959 	    if (addend != 0)
7960 	      info->callbacks->einfo
7961 		/* xgettext:c-format */
7962 		(_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7963 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7964 		 howto->name,
7965 		 sym_name);
7966 	  }
7967 	  break;
7968 
7969 	  /* Relocations that need no special processing.  */
7970 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7971 	  /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7972 	     at a symbol not in this object.  */
7973 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
7974 	    {
7975 	      (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7976 						    h->root.root.string,
7977 						    input_bfd,
7978 						    input_section,
7979 						    rel->r_offset,
7980 						    TRUE);
7981 	      goto copy_reloc;
7982 	    }
7983 	  if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
7984 	    {
7985 	      /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
7986 		 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere.  More
7987 		 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
7988 		 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
7989 		 access the PLT.  The problem is that a call that is
7990 		 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
7991 		 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
7992 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section.  */
7993 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
7994 	      info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
7995 				      input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7996 				      h->root.root.string);
7997 	    }
7998 	  break;
7999 
8000 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8001 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8002 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
8003 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8004 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8005 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8006 	  break;
8007 
8008 	  /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
8009 	     object.  */
8010 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8011 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8012 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8013 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8014 	  if (h != NULL
8015 	      && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8016 	      && h->dynindx == -1)
8017 	    {
8018 	      /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8019 		 resolve to zero.  This is really just a tweak, since
8020 		 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8021 		 defined before using them.  */
8022 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8023 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8024 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8025 	      if (insn != 0)
8026 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8027 	      break;
8028 	    }
8029 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8030 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8031 	  /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8032 	     libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8033 	     DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway.  */
8034 	  goto dodyn;
8035 
8036 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8037 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8038 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8039 	  goto dodyn;
8040 
8041 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8042 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8043 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8044 	  goto dodyn;
8045 
8046 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8047 	  relocation = 1;
8048 	  addend = 0;
8049 	  goto dodyn;
8050 
8051 	case R_PPC_REL16:
8052 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8053 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8054 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8055 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8056 	  break;
8057 
8058 	case R_PPC_REL32:
8059 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8060 	    break;
8061 	  /* fall through */
8062 
8063 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8064 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8065 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8066 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8067 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8068 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8069 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8070 	  goto dodyn;
8071 
8072 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8073 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8074 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8075 	case R_PPC_REL24:
8076 	case R_PPC_REL14:
8077 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8078 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8079 	  /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8080 	     handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker.  */
8081 	  if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8082 	      || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8083 	    break;
8084 	  /* fall through */
8085 
8086 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8087 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8088 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8089 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8090 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8091 	    break;
8092 	  /* fall through */
8093 
8094 	dodyn:
8095 	  if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8096 	      || is_vxworks_tls)
8097 	    break;
8098 
8099 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8100 	      ? ((h == NULL
8101 		  || ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8102 		 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8103 		     || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8104 	      : (h != NULL
8105 		 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8106 	    {
8107 	      int skip;
8108 	      bfd_byte *loc;
8109 	      asection *sreloc;
8110 	      long indx = 0;
8111 
8112 #ifdef DEBUG
8113 	      fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8114 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
8115 		       (h && h->root.root.string
8116 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8117 #endif
8118 
8119 	      /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8120 		 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8121 		 time.  */
8122 	      skip = 0;
8123 	      outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8124 							 input_section,
8125 							 rel->r_offset);
8126 	      if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8127 		  || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8128 		skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8129 	      outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8130 				  + input_section->output_offset);
8131 
8132 	      /* Optimize unaligned reloc use.  */
8133 	      if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8134 		  || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8135 		r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8136 	      if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8137 		  || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8138 		r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8139 
8140 	      if (skip)
8141 		memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8142 	      else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8143 		{
8144 		  indx = h->dynindx;
8145 		  BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8146 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8147 		  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8148 		  outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8149 		}
8150 	      else
8151 		{
8152 		  outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8153 
8154 		  if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8155 		    {
8156 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
8157 			{
8158 			  /* If we get here when building a static
8159 			     executable, then the libc startup function
8160 			     responsible for applying indirect function
8161 			     relocations is going to complain about
8162 			     the reloc type.
8163 			     If we get here when building a dynamic
8164 			     executable, it will be because we have
8165 			     a text relocation.  The dynamic loader
8166 			     will set the text segment writable and
8167 			     non-executable to apply text relocations.
8168 			     So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8169 			     indirection function to resolve the reloc.  */
8170 			  info->callbacks->einfo
8171 			    /* xgettext:c-format */
8172 			    (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8173 			       "function %s unsupported\n"),
8174 			     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8175 			     howto->name,
8176 			     sym_name);
8177 			  ret = FALSE;
8178 			}
8179 		      else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8180 			;
8181 		      else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8182 			{
8183 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8184 			  ret = FALSE;
8185 			}
8186 		      else
8187 			{
8188 			  asection *osec;
8189 
8190 			  /* We are turning this relocation into one
8191 			     against a section symbol.  It would be
8192 			     proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8193 			     osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8194 			     but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8195 			     FIXME: Why not always use a zero index?  */
8196 			  osec = sec->output_section;
8197 			  if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8198 			    {
8199 			      osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8200 			      indx = 0;
8201 			    }
8202 			  else
8203 			    {
8204 			      indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8205 			      if (indx == 0)
8206 				{
8207 				  osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8208 				  indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8209 				}
8210 			      BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8211 			    }
8212 
8213 			  /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8214 			     Don't leave the symbol value in the
8215 			     addend for them.  */
8216 			  if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8217 			    outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8218 			}
8219 
8220 		      outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8221 		    }
8222 		  else if (ifunc != NULL)
8223 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8224 		  else
8225 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8226 		}
8227 
8228 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8229 	      if (ifunc)
8230 		{
8231 		  sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8232 		  if (indx == 0)
8233 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8234 		  else if (is_static_defined (h))
8235 		    htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8236 		}
8237 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
8238 		return FALSE;
8239 
8240 	      loc = sreloc->contents;
8241 	      loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8242 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8243 
8244 	      if (skip == -1)
8245 		goto copy_reloc;
8246 
8247 	      /* This reloc will be computed at runtime.  Clear the memory
8248 		 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink.  */
8249 	      if (!skip)
8250 		{
8251 		  relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8252 		  addend = 0;
8253 		  break;
8254 		}
8255 	    }
8256 	  break;
8257 
8258 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8259 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8260 	  if (h != NULL)
8261 	    {
8262 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
8263 	      bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8264 
8265 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8266 		{
8267 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8268 		    got2_addend = addend;
8269 		  addend = 0;
8270 		}
8271 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8272 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8273 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8274 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
8275 			      + ent->glink_offset);
8276 	      else
8277 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8278 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8279 			      + ent->plt.offset);
8280 	    }
8281 	  /* Fall through.  */
8282 
8283 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
8284 	  {
8285 	    const int *stub;
8286 	    size_t size;
8287 	    size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8288 	    unsigned int insn;
8289 
8290 	    if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8291 	      {
8292 		relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8293 			       + input_section->output_offset
8294 			       + rel->r_offset - 4);
8295 		stub = shared_stub_entry;
8296 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8297 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8298 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8299 		stub += 3;
8300 		size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8301 	      }
8302 	    else
8303 	      {
8304 		stub = stub_entry;
8305 		size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8306 	      }
8307 
8308 	    relocation += addend;
8309 	    if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8310 	      relocation = 0;
8311 
8312 	    /* First insn is HA, second is LO.  */
8313 	    insn = *stub++;
8314 	    insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8315 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8316 	    insn_offset += 4;
8317 
8318 	    insn = *stub++;
8319 	    insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8320 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8321 	    insn_offset += 4;
8322 	    size -= 2;
8323 
8324 	    while (size != 0)
8325 	      {
8326 		insn = *stub++;
8327 		--size;
8328 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8329 		insn_offset += 4;
8330 	      }
8331 
8332 	    /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8333 	       relocs to describe this relocation.  */
8334 	    BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8335 	    /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8336 	    wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8337 	    wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8338 	    wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8339 	    memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8340 	    wrel++, rel++;
8341 	    wrel->r_offset += 4;
8342 	    wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8343 	  }
8344 	  continue;
8345 
8346 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
8347 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8348 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8349 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8350 	    {
8351 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8352 	      break;
8353 	    }
8354 	  relocation
8355 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8356 						 h, relocation, rel);
8357 	  addend = 0;
8358 	  break;
8359 
8360 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
8361 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8362 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8363 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8364 	    {
8365 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8366 	      break;
8367 	    }
8368 	  relocation
8369 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8370 						 h, relocation, rel);
8371 	  addend = 0;
8372 	  break;
8373 
8374 	  /* Handle the TOC16 reloc.  We want to use the offset within the .got
8375 	     section, not the actual VMA.  This is appropriate when generating
8376 	     an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8377 	     AIX .toc section.  */
8378 	case R_PPC_TOC16:			/* phony GOT16 relocations */
8379 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8380 	    {
8381 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8382 	      break;
8383 	    }
8384 	  BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
8385 		      || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
8386 
8387 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8388 	  break;
8389 
8390 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8391 	  if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8392 	    {
8393 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
8394 
8395 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8396 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8397 	      if (ent == NULL
8398 		  || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8399 		{
8400 		  /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol.  This
8401 		     happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8402 		     using -Bsymbolic.  */
8403 		}
8404 	      else
8405 		{
8406 		  /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8407 		     procedure linkage table.  */
8408 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8409 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8410 		    relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8411 				  + htab->glink->output_offset
8412 				  + ent->glink_offset);
8413 		  else
8414 		    relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8415 				  + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8416 				  + ent->plt.offset);
8417 		}
8418 	    }
8419 
8420 	  /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
8421 	     addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8422 	     Don't apply it to the relocation field.  */
8423 	  addend = 0;
8424 	  break;
8425 
8426 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8427 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8428 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8429 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8430 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8431 	  plt_list = NULL;
8432 	  if (h != NULL)
8433 	    plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8434 	  else if (ifunc != NULL)
8435 	    plt_list = ifunc;
8436 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8437 	    {
8438 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8439 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8440 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8441 	      plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8442 	    }
8443 	  unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8444 	  if (plt_list != NULL)
8445 	    {
8446 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
8447 
8448 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8449 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8450 	      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8451 		{
8452 		  asection *plt;
8453 
8454 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8455 		  plt = htab->elf.splt;
8456 		  if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8457 		      || h == NULL
8458 		      || h->dynindx == -1)
8459 		    {
8460 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
8461 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8462 		      else
8463 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
8464 		    }
8465 		  relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8466 				+ plt->output_offset
8467 				+ ent->plt.offset);
8468 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8469 		    {
8470 		      bfd_vma got = 0;
8471 
8472 		      if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8473 			got = (ent->addend
8474 			       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8475 			       + ent->sec->output_offset);
8476 		      else
8477 			got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8478 		      relocation -= got;
8479 		    }
8480 		}
8481 	    }
8482 	  addend = 0;
8483 	  break;
8484 
8485 	  /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_.  */
8486 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8487 	  {
8488 	    const char *name;
8489 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8490 
8491 	    if (sec == NULL
8492 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
8493 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
8494 	      {
8495 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8496 		break;
8497 	      }
8498 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8499 
8500 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8501 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8502 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8503 	      {
8504 		_bfd_error_handler
8505 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
8506 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8507 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8508 		   input_bfd,
8509 		   sym_name,
8510 		   howto->name,
8511 		   name);
8512 	      }
8513 	  }
8514 	  break;
8515 
8516 	  /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_.  */
8517 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8518 	  {
8519 	    const char *name;
8520 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8521 
8522 	    if (sec == NULL
8523 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
8524 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
8525 	      {
8526 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8527 		break;
8528 	      }
8529 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8530 
8531 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8532 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8533 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8534 	      {
8535 		_bfd_error_handler
8536 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
8537 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8538 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8539 		   input_bfd,
8540 		   sym_name,
8541 		   howto->name,
8542 		   name);
8543 	      }
8544 	  }
8545 	  break;
8546 
8547 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8548 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
8549 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8550 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8551 			       split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8552 	  goto copy_reloc;
8553 
8554 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8555 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
8556 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8557 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8558 			       split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8559 	  goto copy_reloc;
8560 
8561 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8562 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8563 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8564 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8565 			       split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8566 	  goto copy_reloc;
8567 
8568 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8569 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8570 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8571 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8572 			       split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8573 	  goto copy_reloc;
8574 
8575 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8576 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8577 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8578 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8579 			       split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8580 	  goto copy_reloc;
8581 
8582 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8583 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8584 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8585 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8586 			       split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8587 	  goto copy_reloc;
8588 
8589 	  /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0.  */
8590 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8591 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8592 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8593 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8594 	  {
8595 	    const char *name;
8596 	    int reg;
8597 	    unsigned int insn;
8598 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8599 
8600 	    if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8601 	      {
8602 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8603 		break;
8604 	      }
8605 
8606 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8607 	    if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8608 		|| strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8609 	      {
8610 		reg = 13;
8611 		sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8612 	      }
8613 	    else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8614 		     || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8615 	      {
8616 		reg = 2;
8617 		sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8618 	      }
8619 	    else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8620 		     || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8621 	      {
8622 		reg = 0;
8623 	      }
8624 	    else
8625 	      {
8626 		_bfd_error_handler
8627 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
8628 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8629 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8630 		   input_bfd,
8631 		   sym_name,
8632 		   howto->name,
8633 		   name);
8634 
8635 		bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8636 		ret = FALSE;
8637 		goto copy_reloc;
8638 	      }
8639 
8640 	    if (sda != NULL)
8641 	      {
8642 		if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8643 		  {
8644 		    unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8645 		    break;
8646 		  }
8647 		addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8648 	      }
8649 
8650 	    if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8651 	      break;
8652 
8653 	    /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8654 	       version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8655 	       operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset.  GNU as and
8656 	       GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8657 	       a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset.  Cope with object file
8658 	       producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8659 	       generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects.  */
8660 	    if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8661 	      rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8662 
8663 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8664 	    if (reg == 0
8665 		&& (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8666 		    || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8667 	      {
8668 		relocation = relocation + addend;
8669 		addend = 0;
8670 
8671 		/* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn.  */
8672 		insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8673 		insn |= 28u << 26;
8674 
8675 		/* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
8676 		/* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
8677 		insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8678 		/* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
8679 		insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8680 		/* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
8681 		insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8682 
8683 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8684 
8685 		if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8686 		    && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8687 		  goto overflow;
8688 		goto copy_reloc;
8689 	      }
8690 	    /* Fill in register field.  */
8691 	    insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8692 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8693 	  }
8694 	  break;
8695 
8696 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8697 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8698 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8699 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8700 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8701 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8702 	  {
8703 	    bfd_vma value;
8704 	    const char *name;
8705 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8706 
8707 	    if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8708 	      {
8709 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8710 		break;
8711 	      }
8712 
8713 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8714 	    if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8715 		|| strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8716 	      sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8717 	    else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8718 		     || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8719 	      sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8720 	    else
8721 	      {
8722 		_bfd_error_handler
8723 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
8724 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8725 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8726 		   input_bfd,
8727 		   sym_name,
8728 		   howto->name,
8729 		   name);
8730 
8731 		bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8732 		ret = FALSE;
8733 		goto copy_reloc;
8734 	      }
8735 
8736 	    if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8737 	      {
8738 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8739 		break;
8740 	      }
8741 	    value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8742 
8743 	    if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8744 	      ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8745 				   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8746 				   split16a_type,
8747 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8748 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8749 	      ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8750 				   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8751 				   split16d_type,
8752 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8753 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8754 	      {
8755 		value = value >> 16;
8756 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8757 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8758 				     split16a_type,
8759 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8760 	      }
8761 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8762 	      {
8763 		value = value >> 16;
8764 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8765 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8766 				     split16d_type,
8767 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8768 	      }
8769 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8770 	      {
8771 		value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8772 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8773 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8774 				     split16a_type,
8775 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8776 	      }
8777 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8778 	      {
8779 		value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8780 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8781 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8782 				     split16d_type,
8783 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8784 	      }
8785 	  }
8786 	  goto copy_reloc;
8787 
8788 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8789 	  ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8790 	  continue;
8791 
8792 	  /* Relocate against the beginning of the section.  */
8793 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8794 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8795 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8796 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8797 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8798 	    {
8799 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8800 	      break;
8801 	    }
8802 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8803 	  break;
8804 
8805 	  /* Negative relocations.  */
8806 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8807 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8808 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8809 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8810 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8811 	  addend -= 2 * relocation;
8812 	  break;
8813 
8814 	case R_PPC_COPY:
8815 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8816 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8817 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8818 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8819 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
8820 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8821 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8822 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8823 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8824 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8825 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8826 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8827 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
8828 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8829 			      input_bfd, howto->name);
8830 
8831 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8832 	  ret = FALSE;
8833 	  goto copy_reloc;
8834 	}
8835 
8836       switch (r_type)
8837 	{
8838 	default:
8839 	  break;
8840 
8841 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8842 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
8843 	    {
8844 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8845 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8846 	      insn &= 1;
8847 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8848 	      unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8849 	      r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8850 	      howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8851 	    }
8852 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8853 	    info->callbacks->einfo
8854 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8855 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8856 	       howto->name);
8857 	  break;
8858 
8859 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8860 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8861 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8862 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
8863 	    {
8864 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8865 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8866 	      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8867 	      r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8868 	      howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8869 	    }
8870 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8871 	    info->callbacks->einfo
8872 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8873 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8874 	       howto->name);
8875 	  break;
8876 	}
8877 
8878       /* Do any further special processing.  */
8879       switch (r_type)
8880 	{
8881 	default:
8882 	  break;
8883 
8884 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8885 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8886 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8887 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8888 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8889 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8890 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8891 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8892 	  /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8893 	     that's not actually defined anywhere.  In that case,
8894 	     'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8895 	     alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link).  */
8896 	  if (sec == NULL)
8897 	    break;
8898 	  /* Fall through.  */
8899 
8900 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8901 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8902 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8903 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8904 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8905 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8906 	  /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8907 	     Bits 0:15 are not used.  */
8908 	  addend += 0x8000;
8909 	  break;
8910 
8911 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8912 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8913 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
8914 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8915 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8916 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8917 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8918 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8919 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8920 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8921 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8922 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8923 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8924 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8925 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8926 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8927 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8928 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8929 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8930 	  {
8931 	    /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8932 	       certain 64-bit instructions.  Prevent damage to bits
8933 	       that make up part of the insn opcode.  */
8934 	    unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8935 
8936 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8937 			       contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8938 	    mask = 0;
8939 	    if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8940 	      mask = 3;
8941 	    else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8942 	      mask = 15;
8943 	    else
8944 	      break;
8945 	    relocation += addend;
8946 	    addend = insn & mask;
8947 	    lobit = mask & relocation;
8948 	    if (lobit != 0)
8949 	      {
8950 		relocation ^= lobit;
8951 		info->callbacks->einfo
8952 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
8953 		  (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8954 		   input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8955 		   howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8956 		bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8957 		ret = FALSE;
8958 	      }
8959 	  }
8960 	  break;
8961 	}
8962 
8963 #ifdef DEBUG
8964       fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8965 	       "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8966 	       howto->name,
8967 	       (int) r_type,
8968 	       sym_name,
8969 	       r_symndx,
8970 	       (long) rel->r_offset,
8971 	       (long) addend);
8972 #endif
8973 
8974       if (unresolved_reloc
8975 	  && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8976 	       && h->def_dynamic)
8977 	  && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
8978 				      rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
8979 	{
8980 	  info->callbacks->einfo
8981 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
8982 	    (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
8983 	     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8984 	     howto->name,
8985 	     sym_name);
8986 	  ret = FALSE;
8987 	}
8988 
8989       /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
8990 	 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values.  Really, we should
8991 	 have different reloc types.  */
8992       if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
8993 	  && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
8994 	  && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
8995 	{
8996 	  enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
8997 
8998 	  if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
8999 	    {
9000 	      unsigned int insn;
9001 
9002 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
9003 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
9004 		complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
9005 	      else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
9006 		       || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
9007 		       || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
9008 		complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
9009 	    }
9010 	  if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9011 	    {
9012 	      alt_howto = *howto;
9013 	      alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9014 	      howto = &alt_howto;
9015 	    }
9016 	}
9017 
9018       if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9019 	{
9020 	  /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate.  */
9021 	  if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
9022 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9023 	  else
9024 	    {
9025 	      unsigned int insn;
9026 
9027 	      relocation += addend;
9028 	      relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9029 			     + input_section->output_offset
9030 			     + input_section->output_section->vma);
9031 	      relocation >>= 16;
9032 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9033 	      insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9034 	      insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9035 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9036 	      r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9037 	    }
9038 	}
9039       else
9040 	r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9041 				      rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9042 
9043       if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9044 	{
9045 	  if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9046 	    {
9047 	    overflow:
9048 	      /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9049 		 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined.  */
9050 	      if (!warned
9051 		  && !(h != NULL
9052 		       && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9053 			   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9054 		       && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9055 		info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9056 		  (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9057 		   rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9058 	    }
9059 	  else
9060 	    {
9061 	      info->callbacks->einfo
9062 		/* xgettext:c-format */
9063 		(_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9064 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9065 		 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9066 	      ret = FALSE;
9067 	    }
9068 	}
9069     copy_reloc:
9070       if (wrel != rel)
9071 	*wrel = *rel;
9072     }
9073 
9074   if (wrel != rel)
9075     {
9076       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9077       size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9078 
9079       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9080       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9081       if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9082 	{
9083 	  /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section.  Leave
9084 	     one NONE reloc.
9085 	     ??? What is wrong with an empty section???  */
9086 	  rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9087 	  deleted -= 1;
9088 	  wrel++;
9089 	}
9090       relend = wrel;
9091       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9092       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9093       input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9094     }
9095 
9096 #ifdef DEBUG
9097   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9098 #endif
9099 
9100   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9101       && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9102       && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9103 	  || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9104     {
9105       /* Branch around the trampolines.  */
9106       unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9107       bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9108     }
9109 
9110   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9111       && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9112       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9113 	  || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9114 	      >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9115     {
9116       bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9117       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9118 
9119       if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9120 	{
9121 	  bfd_byte *p;
9122 	  unsigned int n;
9123 	  bfd_byte fill[4];
9124 
9125 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9126 	  p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9127 	  n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9128 	  while (n--)
9129 	    {
9130 	      memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9131 	      p += 4;
9132 	    }
9133 	}
9134 
9135       /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9136 	 branch to a patch area.  Put the insn there followed by a
9137 	 branch back to the next page.  Complicated a little by
9138 	 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9139 	 wanting to touch data-in-text.  */
9140 
9141       start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9142 		    + input_section->output_offset);
9143       end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9144 		  - relax_info->workaround_size);
9145       for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9146 	   addr < end_addr;
9147 	   addr += pagesize)
9148 	{
9149 	  bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9150 	  Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9151 	  bfd_boolean is_data;
9152 	  bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9153 	  unsigned int insn;
9154 
9155 	  /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset?  If so, leave
9156 	     the word alone.  */
9157 	  is_data = FALSE;
9158 	  lo = relocs;
9159 	  hi = relend;
9160 	  rel = NULL;
9161 	  while (lo < hi)
9162 	    {
9163 	      rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9164 	      if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9165 		lo = rel + 1;
9166 	      else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9167 		hi = rel;
9168 	      else
9169 		{
9170 		  switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9171 		    {
9172 		    case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9173 		    case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9174 		    case R_PPC_REL32:
9175 		    case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9176 		      is_data = TRUE;
9177 		      break;
9178 		    default:
9179 		      break;
9180 		    }
9181 		  break;
9182 		}
9183 	    }
9184 	  if (is_data)
9185 	    continue;
9186 
9187 	  /* Some instructions can be left alone too.  Unconditional
9188 	     branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9189 	     avoid the icache failure.
9190 
9191 	     The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9192 	     where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9193 	     page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9194 	     instructions fails under certain circumstances.  The
9195 	     unconditional branches:
9196 	     1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9197 	     2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9198 	     3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9199 	     where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9200 	     prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9201 	     affected by these instructions.  This happens even if the
9202 	     instruction is not executed.
9203 
9204 	     A bctr example:
9205 	     .
9206 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha
9207 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l
9208 	     .	mtctr 9
9209 	     .	bctr
9210 	     .	nop
9211 	     .	nop
9212 	     . new_page:
9213 	     .
9214 	     The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9215 	     ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9216 	     new page which might have stale instructions.  If they
9217 	     fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9218 	     bctr executes.  Either of the following modifications
9219 	     prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9220 	     place:
9221 	     .
9222 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha	 lis 9,new_page@ha
9223 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l	 addi 9,9,new_page@l
9224 	     .	mtctr 9			 mtctr 9
9225 	     .	bctr			 bctr
9226 	     .	nop			 b somewhere_else
9227 	     .	b somewhere_else	 nop
9228 	     . new_page:		new_page:
9229 	     .  */
9230 	  insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9231 	  if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26)	    /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9232 	      || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26)	    /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9233 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /*	 with BO=0x14 */
9234 	      || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9235 		  && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1)    /* bclr,bclrl */
9236 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/*	 with BO=0x14 */
9237 	    continue;
9238 
9239 	  patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9240 			- relax_info->workaround_size);
9241 	  patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9242 	  patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9243 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9244 
9245 	  if (rel != NULL
9246 	      && rel->r_offset >= offset
9247 	      && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9248 	    {
9249 	      asection *sreloc;
9250 
9251 	      /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9252 		 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9253 		 location.  This matters for -r and --emit-relocs.  */
9254 	      if (rel + 1 != relend)
9255 		{
9256 		  Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9257 
9258 		  /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset.  */
9259 		  memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9260 		  relend[-1] = tmp;
9261 		}
9262 	      relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9263 
9264 	      /* Adjust REL16 addends too.  */
9265 	      switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9266 		{
9267 		case R_PPC_REL16:
9268 		case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9269 		case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9270 		case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9271 		  relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9272 		  break;
9273 		default:
9274 		  break;
9275 		}
9276 
9277 	      /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9278 		 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9279 		 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn.  */
9280 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9281 	      if (sreloc != NULL)
9282 		{
9283 		  Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9284 		  bfd_vma soffset;
9285 
9286 		  slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9287 		  shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9288 		  soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9289 			     + input_section->output_offset);
9290 		  while (slo < shi)
9291 		    {
9292 		      Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9293 		      bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9294 						&outrel);
9295 		      if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9296 			slo = srel + 1;
9297 		      else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9298 			shi = srel;
9299 		      else
9300 			{
9301 			  if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9302 			    {
9303 			      memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9304 				       (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9305 			      srel = srelend - 1;
9306 			    }
9307 			  outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9308 			  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9309 						     (bfd_byte *) srel);
9310 			  break;
9311 			}
9312 		    }
9313 		}
9314 	    }
9315 	  else
9316 	    rel = NULL;
9317 
9318 	  if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9319 	      && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9320 	    {
9321 	      bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9322 
9323 	      delta += offset - patch_off;
9324 	      if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9325 		delta = 0;
9326 	      if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9327 		{
9328 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9329 
9330 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9331 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9332 		    insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9333 		  else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9334 		    insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9335 		  else
9336 		    BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9337 
9338 		  if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9339 		       || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9340 		      && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9341 		      && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9342 		    insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9343 		}
9344 	      if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9345 		{
9346 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9347 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9348 			      contents + patch_off);
9349 		  patch_off += 4;
9350 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9351 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9352 			      contents + patch_off);
9353 		  patch_off += 4;
9354 		}
9355 	      else
9356 		{
9357 		  if (rel != NULL)
9358 		    {
9359 		      unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9360 
9361 		      relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9362 		      relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9363 		    }
9364 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9365 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9366 			      contents + patch_off);
9367 		  patch_off += 4;
9368 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9369 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9370 			      contents + patch_off);
9371 		  patch_off += 4;
9372 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9373 			      B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9374 			      contents + patch_off);
9375 		  patch_off += 4;
9376 		}
9377 	    }
9378 	  else
9379 	    {
9380 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9381 	      patch_off += 4;
9382 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9383 			  B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9384 			  contents + patch_off);
9385 	      patch_off += 4;
9386 	    }
9387 	  BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9388 	  relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9389 	}
9390     }
9391 
9392   return ret;
9393 }
9394 
9395 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H.  */
9396 
9397 static bfd_boolean
write_global_sym_plt(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * inf)9398 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9399 {
9400   struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9401   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9402   struct plt_entry *ent;
9403   bfd_boolean doneone;
9404 
9405   doneone = FALSE;
9406   for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9407     if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9408       {
9409 	if (!doneone)
9410 	  {
9411 	    Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9412 	    bfd_byte *loc;
9413 	    bfd_vma reloc_index;
9414 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9415 	    asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9416 
9417 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9418 		|| !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9419 		|| h->dynindx == -1)
9420 	      reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9421 	    else
9422 	      {
9423 		reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9424 			       / htab->plt_slot_size);
9425 		if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9426 		    && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9427 		  reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9428 	      }
9429 
9430 	    /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9431 	       Set it up.  */
9432 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9433 		&& htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9434 		&& h->dynindx != -1)
9435 	      {
9436 		bfd_vma got_offset;
9437 		const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9438 
9439 		/* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved.  */
9440 		got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9441 
9442 		/* Use the right PLT. */
9443 		plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9444 			    : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9445 
9446 		/* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks.  */
9447 		if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9448 		  {
9449 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9450 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9451 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9452 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9453 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9454 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9455 		  }
9456 		else
9457 		  {
9458 		    bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9459 
9460 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9461 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9462 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9463 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9464 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9465 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9466 		  }
9467 
9468 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9469 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9470 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9471 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9472 
9473 		/* This instruction is an immediate load.  The value loaded is
9474 		   the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9475 		   start of the .rela.plt section.  The value is stored in the
9476 		   low-order 16 bits of the load instruction.  */
9477 		/* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9478 		   prescaled offset.  */
9479 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9480 			    plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9481 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9482 		/* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9483 		   the start of the PLT section.  The address of this branch
9484 		   instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9485 		   The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive.  The value
9486 		   stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9487 		   offset.  */
9488 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9489 			    (plt_entry[5]
9490 			     | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9491 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9492 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9493 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9494 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9495 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9496 
9497 		/* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9498 		   the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9499 		   in this PLT entry.  */
9500 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9501 					       + plt->output_offset
9502 					       + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9503 			    htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9504 
9505 		if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9506 		  {
9507 		    /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded.  */
9508 		    loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9509 		      + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9510 			  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9511 			 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9512 
9513 		    /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
9514 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9515 				     + plt->output_offset
9516 				     + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9517 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9518 						R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9519 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9520 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9521 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9522 
9523 		    /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
9524 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9525 				     + plt->output_offset
9526 				     + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9527 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9528 						R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9529 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9530 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9531 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9532 
9533 		    /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9534 		       PLT slot.  Point it at the middle of the .plt entry.  */
9535 		    rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9536 				     + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9537 				     + got_offset);
9538 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9539 						R_PPC_ADDR32);
9540 		    rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9541 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9542 		  }
9543 
9544 		/* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9545 		   In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9546 		   address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9547 		   by the ABI.  Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9548 		   the GOT slot for this function.  See EABI 4.4.4.1.  */
9549 		rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9550 				 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9551 				 + got_offset);
9552 		rela.r_addend = 0;
9553 	      }
9554 	    else
9555 	      {
9556 		rela.r_addend = 0;
9557 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9558 		    || h->dynindx == -1)
9559 		  {
9560 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9561 		      {
9562 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9563 			relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9564 		      }
9565 		    else
9566 		      {
9567 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
9568 			relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9569 		      }
9570 		    if (h->def_regular
9571 			&& (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9572 			    || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9573 		      rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9574 		  }
9575 
9576 		if (relplt == NULL)
9577 		  {
9578 		    loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9579 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9580 		  }
9581 		else
9582 		  {
9583 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9584 				     + plt->output_offset
9585 				     + ent->plt.offset);
9586 
9587 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9588 			|| !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9589 			|| h->dynindx == -1)
9590 		      {
9591 			/* We don't need to fill in the .plt.  The ppc dynamic
9592 			   linker will fill it in.  */
9593 		      }
9594 		    else
9595 		      {
9596 			bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9597 				       + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9598 				       + htab->glink->output_offset);
9599 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9600 				    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9601 		      }
9602 		  }
9603 	      }
9604 
9605 	    if (relplt != NULL)
9606 	      {
9607 		/* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
9608 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9609 		    || h->dynindx == -1)
9610 		  {
9611 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9612 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9613 		    else
9614 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9615 		    loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9616 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9617 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9618 		  }
9619 		else
9620 		  {
9621 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9622 		    loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9623 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9624 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9625 		      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9626 		  }
9627 		bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9628 	      }
9629 	    doneone = TRUE;
9630 	  }
9631 
9632 	if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9633 	    || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9634 	    || h->dynindx == -1)
9635 	  {
9636 	    unsigned char *p;
9637 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9638 
9639 	    if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9640 		|| h->dynindx == -1)
9641 	      {
9642 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9643 		  plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9644 		else
9645 		  break;
9646 	      }
9647 
9648 	    p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9649 	    write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9650 
9651 	    if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9652 	      /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub.  */
9653 	      break;
9654 	  }
9655 	else
9656 	  break;
9657       }
9658   return TRUE;
9659 }
9660 
9661 /* Finish up PLT handling.  */
9662 
9663 bfd_boolean
ppc_finish_symbols(struct bfd_link_info * info)9664 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9665 {
9666   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9667   bfd *ibfd;
9668 
9669   if (!htab)
9670     return TRUE;
9671 
9672   elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9673 
9674   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9675     {
9676       bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9677       struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9678       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9679       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9680       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9681       struct plt_entry *ent;
9682 
9683       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9684 	continue;
9685 
9686       local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9687       if (!local_got)
9688 	continue;
9689 
9690       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9691       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9692       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9693       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9694       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9695       for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9696 	for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9697 	  {
9698 	    if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9699 	      {
9700 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9701 		asection *sym_sec;
9702 		asection *plt, *relplt;
9703 		bfd_byte *loc;
9704 		bfd_vma val;
9705 		Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9706 		unsigned char *p;
9707 
9708 		if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9709 				lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9710 		  {
9711 		    if (local_syms != NULL
9712 			&& symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9713 		      free (local_syms);
9714 		    return FALSE;
9715 		  }
9716 
9717 		val = sym->st_value;
9718 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9719 		  val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9720 
9721 		if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9722 		  {
9723 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9724 		    plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9725 		    relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9726 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9727 		  }
9728 		else
9729 		  {
9730 		    plt = htab->pltlocal;
9731 		    if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9732 		      {
9733 			relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9734 			rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9735 		      }
9736 		    else
9737 		      {
9738 			loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9739 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9740 			continue;
9741 		      }
9742 		  }
9743 
9744 		rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9745 				 + plt->output_offset
9746 				 + plt->output_section->vma);
9747 		rela.r_addend = val;
9748 		loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9749 					  * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9750 		bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9751 
9752 		p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9753 		write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9754 	      }
9755 	  }
9756 
9757       if (local_syms != NULL
9758 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9759 	{
9760 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
9761 	    free (local_syms);
9762 	  else
9763 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9764 	}
9765     }
9766   return TRUE;
9767 }
9768 
9769 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  We set the contents of various
9770    dynamic sections here.  */
9771 
9772 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)9773 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9774 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
9775 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9776 			       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9777 {
9778   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9779   struct plt_entry *ent;
9780 
9781 #ifdef DEBUG
9782   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9783 	   h->root.root.string);
9784 #endif
9785 
9786   if (!h->def_regular
9787       || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9788     for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9789       if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9790 	{
9791 	  if (!h->def_regular)
9792 	    {
9793 	      /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9794 		 defined in the .plt section.  Leave the value if
9795 		 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9796 		 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9797 		 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9798 		 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9799 		 to zero.  */
9800 	      sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9801 	      if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9802 		sym->st_value = 0;
9803 	      else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9804 		{
9805 		  /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9806 		     that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9807 		     function pointer.  */
9808 		  sym->st_value = 0;
9809 		}
9810 	    }
9811 	  else
9812 	    {
9813 	      /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9814 		 executable to the glink entry.  This is to avoid
9815 		 text relocations.  We can't do this for ifunc in
9816 		 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9817 		 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9818 		 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9819 		 relocation.  */
9820 	      sym->st_shndx
9821 		= (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9822 		   (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9823 	      sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9824 			       + htab->glink->output_offset
9825 			       + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9826 	    }
9827 	  break;
9828 	}
9829 
9830   if (h->needs_copy)
9831     {
9832       asection *s;
9833       Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9834       bfd_byte *loc;
9835 
9836       /* This symbols needs a copy reloc.  Set it up.  */
9837 
9838 #ifdef DEBUG
9839       fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9840 #endif
9841 
9842       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9843 
9844       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9845 	s = htab->relsbss;
9846       else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9847 	s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9848       else
9849 	s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9850       BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9851 
9852       rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9853       rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9854       rela.r_addend = 0;
9855       loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9856       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9857     }
9858 
9859 #ifdef DEBUG
9860   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9861 #endif
9862 
9863   return TRUE;
9864 }
9865 
9866 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
ppc_elf_reloc_type_class(const struct bfd_link_info * info,const asection * rel_sec,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rela)9867 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9868 			  const asection *rel_sec,
9869 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9870 {
9871   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9872 
9873   if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9874     return reloc_class_ifunc;
9875 
9876   switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9877     {
9878     case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9879       return reloc_class_relative;
9880     case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9881       return reloc_class_plt;
9882     case R_PPC_COPY:
9883       return reloc_class_copy;
9884     default:
9885       return reloc_class_normal;
9886     }
9887 }
9888 
9889 /* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
9890 
9891 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)9892 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9893 				 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9894 {
9895   asection *sdyn;
9896   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9897   bfd_vma got;
9898   bfd *dynobj;
9899   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9900 
9901 #ifdef DEBUG
9902   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9903 #endif
9904 
9905   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9906   dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9907   sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9908 
9909   got = 0;
9910   if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9911     got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9912 
9913   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9914     {
9915       Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9916 
9917       BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9918 
9919       dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9920       dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9921       for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9922 	{
9923 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9924 	  asection *s;
9925 
9926 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9927 
9928 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
9929 	    {
9930 	    case DT_PLTGOT:
9931 	      if (htab->is_vxworks)
9932 		s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9933 	      else
9934 		s = htab->elf.splt;
9935 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9936 	      break;
9937 
9938 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9939 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9940 	      break;
9941 
9942 	    case DT_JMPREL:
9943 	      s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9944 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9945 	      break;
9946 
9947 	    case DT_PPC_GOT:
9948 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9949 	      break;
9950 
9951 	    case DT_TEXTREL:
9952 	      if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9953 		info->callbacks->einfo
9954 		  (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9955 		     "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9956 	      else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9957 		info->callbacks->einfo
9958 		  (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9959 		     "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9960 	      continue;
9961 
9962 	    default:
9963 	      if (htab->is_vxworks
9964 		  && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9965 		break;
9966 	      continue;
9967 	    }
9968 
9969 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9970 	}
9971     }
9972 
9973   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9974       && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9975     {
9976       if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
9977 	  || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
9978 	{
9979 	  unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
9980 
9981 	  p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
9982 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9983 	    {
9984 	      /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
9985 		 so that a function can easily find the address of
9986 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
9987 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
9988 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9989 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
9990 	    }
9991 
9992 	  if (sdyn != NULL)
9993 	    {
9994 	      bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
9995 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
9996 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9997 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
9998 	    }
9999 	}
10000       else
10001 	{
10002 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
10003 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
10004 			      htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
10005 			      (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
10006 			       ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
10007 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10008 	  ret = FALSE;
10009 	}
10010 
10011       elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10012     }
10013 
10014   /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table.  */
10015   if (htab->is_vxworks
10016       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10017       && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10018       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10019     {
10020       asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10021       /* Use the right PLT. */
10022       const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10023 				  ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10024 				  : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10025 
10026       if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10027 	{
10028 	  bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10029 
10030 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10031 		      splt->contents +  0);
10032 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10033 		      splt->contents +  4);
10034 	}
10035       else
10036 	{
10037 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents +  0);
10038 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents +  4);
10039 	}
10040       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents +  8);
10041       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10042       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10043       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10044       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10045       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10046 
10047       if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10048 	{
10049 	  Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10050 	  bfd_byte *loc;
10051 
10052 	  loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10053 
10054 	  /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
10055 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10056 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10057 			   + 2);
10058 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10059 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
10060 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10061 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10062 
10063 	  /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
10064 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10065 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10066 			   + 6);
10067 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10068 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
10069 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10070 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10071 
10072 	  /* Fix up the remaining relocations.  They may have the wrong
10073 	     symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10074 	     in which symbols were output.  */
10075 	  while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10076 	    {
10077 	      Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10078 
10079 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10080 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10081 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10082 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10083 
10084 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10085 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10086 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10087 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10088 
10089 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10090 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10091 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10092 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10093 	    }
10094 	}
10095     }
10096 
10097   if (htab->glink != NULL
10098       && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10099       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10100     {
10101       unsigned char *p;
10102       unsigned char *endp;
10103       bfd_vma res0;
10104 
10105       /*
10106        * PIC glink code is the following:
10107        *
10108        * # ith PLT code stub.
10109        *   addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10110        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10111        *   mtctr 11
10112        *   bctr
10113        *
10114        * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10115        * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10116        * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10117        * res_0:	b PLTresolve
10118        * res_1:	b PLTresolve
10119        * .
10120        * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10121        * res_n_m3: nop
10122        * res_n_m2: nop
10123        * res_n_m1:
10124        *
10125        * PLTresolve:
10126        *    addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10127        *    mflr 0
10128        *    bcl 20,31,1f
10129        * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10130        *    mflr 12
10131        *    mtlr 0
10132        *    sub 11,11,12		# r11 = index * 4
10133        *    addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10134        *    lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12)	# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10135        *    lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
10136        *    mtctr 0
10137        *    add 0,11,11
10138        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10139        *    bctr
10140        *
10141        * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10142        *
10143        * # ith PLT code stub.
10144        *   lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10145        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10146        *   mtctr 11
10147        *   bctr
10148        *
10149        * The branch table is the same, then comes
10150        *
10151        * PLTresolve:
10152        *    lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10153        *    addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10154        *    lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12)		# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10155        *    addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l	# r11 = index * 4
10156        *    mtctr 0
10157        *    add 0,11,11
10158        *    lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
10159        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10160        *    bctr
10161        */
10162 
10163       /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10164 	 and perhaps some padding.  */
10165       p = htab->glink->contents;
10166       p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10167       endp = htab->glink->contents;
10168       endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10169       while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10170 	{
10171 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10172 	  p += 4;
10173 	}
10174       while (p < endp)
10175 	{
10176 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10177 	  p += 4;
10178 	}
10179 
10180       res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10181 	      + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10182 	      + htab->glink->output_offset);
10183 
10184       if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10185 	{
10186 	  /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10187 	     result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10188 	     glink branch table.  */
10189 	  bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10190 	  bfd_vma page_addr;
10191 	  bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10192 				 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10193 
10194 	  for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10195 	       page_addr > glink_start;
10196 	       page_addr -= pagesize)
10197 	    {
10198 	      /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing.  */
10199 	      bfd_byte *loc;
10200 	      unsigned int insn;
10201 
10202 	      loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10203 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10204 	      if (insn == BCTR)
10205 		{
10206 		  /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10207 		     one other call stub before this one.  */
10208 		  insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10209 		  if (insn == BCTR)
10210 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10211 		  else
10212 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10213 		}
10214 	    }
10215 	}
10216 
10217       /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub.  */
10218       endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10219       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10220 	{
10221 	  bfd_vma bcl;
10222 
10223 	  bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10224 		 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10225 		 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10226 
10227 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10228 	  p += 4;
10229 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10230 	  p += 4;
10231 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10232 	  p += 4;
10233 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10234 	  p += 4;
10235 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10236 	  p += 4;
10237 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10238 	  p += 4;
10239 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10240 	  p += 4;
10241 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10242 	  p += 4;
10243 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10244 	    {
10245 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10246 	      p += 4;
10247 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10248 	      p += 4;
10249 	    }
10250 	  else
10251 	    {
10252 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10253 	      p += 4;
10254 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10255 	      p += 4;
10256 	    }
10257 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10258 	  p += 4;
10259 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10260 	}
10261       else
10262 	{
10263 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10264 	  p += 4;
10265 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10266 	  p += 4;
10267 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10268 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10269 	  else
10270 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10271 	  p += 4;
10272 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10273 	  p += 4;
10274 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10275 	  p += 4;
10276 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10277 	  p += 4;
10278 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10279 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10280 	  else
10281 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10282 	}
10283       p += 4;
10284       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10285       p += 4;
10286       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10287       p += 4;
10288       while (p < endp)
10289 	{
10290 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10291 		      htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10292 	  p += 4;
10293 	}
10294       BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10295     }
10296 
10297   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10298       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10299     {
10300       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10301       bfd_vma val;
10302 
10303       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10304       /* FDE length.  */
10305       p += 4;
10306       /* CIE pointer.  */
10307       p += 4;
10308       /* Offset to .glink.  */
10309       val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10310 	     + htab->glink->output_offset);
10311       val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10312 	      + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10313       val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10314       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10315 
10316       if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10317 	  && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10318 					       htab->glink_eh_frame,
10319 					       htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10320 	return FALSE;
10321     }
10322 
10323   return ret;
10324 }
10325 
10326 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM	powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10327 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME	"elf32-powerpcle"
10328 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vec
10329 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc"
10330 #define ELF_ARCH		bfd_arch_powerpc
10331 #define ELF_TARGET_ID		PPC32_ELF_DATA
10332 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE	EM_PPC
10333 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE		0x10000
10334 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE	0x1000
10335 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE	ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10336 #define elf_info_to_howto	ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10337 
10338 #ifdef  EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10339 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1	EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10340 #endif
10341 
10342 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10343 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2	EM_PPC_OLD
10344 #endif
10345 
10346 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded	1
10347 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro	1
10348 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections	1
10349 #define elf_backend_can_refcount	1
10350 #define elf_backend_rela_normal		1
10351 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize	1
10352 
10353 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject			ppc_elf_mkobject
10354 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data	ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10355 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section		ppc_elf_relax_section
10356 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10357 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10358 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags		ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10359 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create	ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10360 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab		ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10361 
10362 #define elf_backend_object_p			ppc_elf_object_p
10363 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook		ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10364 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr		ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10365 #define elf_backend_relocate_section		ppc_elf_relocate_section
10366 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10367 #define elf_backend_check_relocs		ppc_elf_check_relocs
10368 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible		_bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10369 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol	ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10370 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10371 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook		ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10372 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10373 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol			ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10374 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10375 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10376 #define elf_backend_fake_sections		ppc_elf_fake_sections
10377 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers	ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10378 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map		ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10379 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus		ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10380 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo			ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10381 #define elf_backend_write_core_note		ppc_elf_write_core_note
10382 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class		ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10383 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing	ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10384 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing	ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10385 #define elf_backend_write_section		ppc_elf_write_section
10386 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr		ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10387 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val			ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10388 #define elf_backend_action_discarded		ppc_elf_action_discarded
10389 #define elf_backend_init_index_section		_bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10390 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook	ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10391 
10392 #include "elf32-target.h"
10393 
10394 /* FreeBSD Target */
10395 
10396 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10397 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10398 
10399 #undef  TARGET_BIG_SYM
10400 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM  powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10401 #undef  TARGET_BIG_NAME
10402 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10403 
10404 #undef  ELF_OSABI
10405 #define ELF_OSABI	ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10406 
10407 #undef  elf32_bed
10408 #define elf32_bed	elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10409 
10410 #include "elf32-target.h"
10411 
10412 /* VxWorks Target */
10413 
10414 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10415 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10416 
10417 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10418 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10419 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10420 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10421 
10422 #undef  ELF_OSABI
10423 
10424 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt.  */
10425 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)10426 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10427 {
10428   if (sec->name == NULL)
10429     return NULL;
10430 
10431   if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10432     return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10433 
10434   return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10435 }
10436 
10437 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10438    appropriately for VxWorks.  */
10439 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)10440 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10441 {
10442   struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10443 
10444   ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10445   if (ret)
10446     {
10447       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10448 	= (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10449       htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10450       htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10451       htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10452       htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10453       htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10454     }
10455   return ret;
10456 }
10457 
10458 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded.  */
10459 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,const char ** namep,flagword * flagsp,asection ** secp,bfd_vma * valp)10460 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10461 				 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10462 				 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10463 				 const char **namep,
10464 				 flagword *flagsp,
10465 				 asection **secp,
10466 				 bfd_vma *valp)
10467 {
10468   if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10469 				    valp))
10470     return FALSE;
10471 
10472   return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10473 }
10474 
10475 static bfd_boolean
ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing(bfd * abfd)10476 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10477 {
10478   ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10479   return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10480 }
10481 
10482 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10483    define it.  */
10484 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10485 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym		1
10486 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10487 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt		1
10488 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10489 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset		0
10490 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10491 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded		0
10492 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10493 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly		1
10494 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10495 #define elf_backend_got_header_size		12
10496 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10497 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt		1
10498 
10499 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10500 
10501 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10502 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10503   ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10504 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10505 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10506   ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10507 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10508 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10509   elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10510 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10511 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10512   ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10513 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10514 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10515   ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10516 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10517 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10518   elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10519 
10520 #undef elf32_bed
10521 #define elf32_bed				ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10522 
10523 #include "elf32-target.h"
10524